Powerware Power Supply 100160 kVA User Manual

®
Powerware 9390 UPS  
100–160 kVA  
Installation and Operation Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1  
1.1 Basic System Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2  
1.2 Using This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3  
1.3 Conventions Used in This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
1.4 Safety Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5  
1.5 For More Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6  
1.6 Getting Help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6  
Section I – Installation  
2 UPS Installation Plan and Unpacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1  
2.1 Creating an Installation Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1  
2.2 Preparing the Site . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1  
2.2.1 Environmental Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
2.2.2 Preparing for Wiring the UPS System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
2.3 Inspecting and Unpacking the UPS Cabinet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
3 Installing the UPS System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
3.1 Preliminary Installation Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
3.2 UPS Cabinet Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
3.2.1 Unloading the Powerware 9390 UPS Cabinet from the Pallet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2  
3.2.2 Battery Cabinet Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5  
3.2.3 Integrated Distribution Cabinet Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6  
3.2.4 Integrated Accessory Cabinet Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6  
3.2.5 UPS Sidecar Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6  
3.2.6 Installing UPS External and Battery Power Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6  
3.2.6.1  
3.2.6.2  
3.2.6.3  
External Wiring Installation Procedure A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7  
External Wiring Installation Procedure B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Battery Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
3.2.7 Installing Interface Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
3.2.7.1  
3.2.7.2  
3.2.7.3  
TB1 and TB2 Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
TB2 Battery Cabinet Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
X-Slot Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13  
3.2.8 Installing Accessories and Parallel System Control Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
3.3 Initial Startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
3.4 Completing the Installation Checklist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
®
i
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
4 Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1  
4.1 Important Safety Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1  
4.2 Installing Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2  
4.3 Recycling the Used Battery or UPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2  
5 Installing a Remote Emergency Power-off Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1  
6 Installing Options and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1  
6.1 Installing a Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1  
6.2 Installing Parallel System Control Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2  
6.3 Installing a Remote Monitor Panel II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3  
6.4 Installing a Relay Interface Module II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
6.5 Installing a Supervisory Contact Module II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Section II – Operation  
7 Understanding UPS Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1  
7.1 Looking Inside the UPS System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1  
7.2 Single Module Reverse Transfer (RT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2  
7.2.1 Single Module RT Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2  
7.2.2 Normal Mode – RT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4  
7.2.3 Bypass Mode – RT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6  
7.2.4 Battery Mode – RT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8  
7.3 Multiple Module Parallel System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9  
7.3.1 Multiple Module Parallel System Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10  
7.3.2 Normal Mode – Parallel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11  
7.3.3 Bypass Mode – Parallel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12  
7.3.4 Battery Mode – Parallel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14  
7.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15  
7.4.1 Input Rectifier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15  
7.4.2 Inverter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15  
7.4.3 Battery Charger and Advanced Battery Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15  
7.4.4 Bypass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-16  
7.4.5 Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-16  
®
ii  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
8 Features, Options, and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1  
8.1 UPS Standard Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1  
8.1.1 Control Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1  
8.1.2 Customer Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1  
8.1.2.1  
8.1.2.2  
Building Alarm Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1  
Alarm Contact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1  
8.1.3 X-Slot Communication Bay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1  
8.1.4 ConnectUPS-X Web/SNMP Card X-Slot Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1  
8.1.5 Advanced Battery Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
8.1.6 LanSafe Power Management Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
8.1.7 Installation Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
8.2 Options and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
8.2.1 Integrated Battery Cabinets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
8.2.2 Integrated Distribution Cabinet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
8.2.3 Integrated Accessory Cabinet (IAC-B, IAC-T, and IAC-D) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3  
8.2.4 Powerware Hot Sync Parallel System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3  
8.2.5 Sync Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3  
8.2.6 Optional X-Slot Cards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3  
8.2.7 Mini-CSB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3  
8.2.8 Remote Monitor Panel II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4  
8.2.9 Relay Interface Module II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4  
8.2.10 Supervisory Contact Module II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4  
8.3 Symbols, Controls, and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4  
9 Using the Control Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1  
9.1 Using the LCD and Pushbuttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2  
9.2 Using the Main Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3  
9.2.1 Mimic Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3  
9.2.2 Event Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4  
9.2.3 Unit Meter Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6  
9.2.4 Battery Discharge Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9  
9.2.5 KW Demand Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11  
9.2.6 Maximum Current Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-19  
9.2.7 System Meters Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-28  
9.2.8 System Setup Level 0 Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-33  
9.2.9 System Setup Level 1 Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-36  
®
iii  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
9.3 System Controls Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-45  
9.4 Load Off Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-47  
9.5 Reading the Status Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-48  
10 UPS Operating Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-1  
10.1 Single Module Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-1  
10.1.1 Starting the UPS in Normal Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-1  
10.1.2 Starting the UPS in Bypass Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-2  
10.1.3 Starting the Power Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3  
10.1.4 Transfer from Normal to Bypass Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3  
10.1.5 Transfer from Bypass to Normal Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4  
10.1.6 Transfer from Normal to Bypass Mode and Shut Down UPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4  
10.1.7 UPS and Critical Load Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-5  
10.1.8 Charger Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-5  
10.1.9 Using the UPS LOAD OFF Pushbutton . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6  
10.1.10 Using the Remote Emergency Power-off Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7  
10.2 Multiple Module Parallel Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8  
10.2.1 Starting the Parallel System in Normal Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8  
10.2.2 Starting the Parallel System in Bypass Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9  
10.2.3 Transfer Parallel System from Normal to Bypass Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10  
10.2.4 Transfer Parallel System from Bypass to Normal Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10  
10.2.5 Single UPM Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-11  
10.2.6 Restarting a Single UPM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-11  
10.2.7 Parallel System and Critical Load Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12  
10.2.8 Using the UPS LOAD OFF Pushbutton . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-13  
10.2.9 Using the Parallel System Remote Emergency Power-off Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14  
11 Using Features and Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1  
11.1 Building Alarm Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1  
11.2 General Purpose Relay Contact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1  
11.3 Optional Remote Monitor Panel II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-2  
11.4 Relay Interface Module II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4  
11.5 Supervisory Contact Module II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5  
12 Responding to System Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1  
12.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1  
12.2 System Event Horns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1  
12.3 System Event Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1  
12.4 System Event Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-1  
®
iv  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
13 Communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-1  
13.1 X-Slot Cards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-1  
13.2 LanSafe Power Management Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-2  
13.3 Remote Notification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-2  
13.4 Terminal Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-3  
13.4.1 Display UPS Control Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-3  
13.4.2 Event History Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-4  
14 Maintaining the UPS System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-1  
14.1 Important Safety Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-1  
14.2 Performing Preventive Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-2  
14.2.1 DAILY Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-2  
14.2.2 MONTHLY Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-3  
14.2.3 ANNUAL Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-3  
14.2.4 BATTERY Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-3  
14.3 Maintenance Training . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-3  
15 Product Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-1  
15.1 Model Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-1  
15.2 Single Module Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-1  
15.2.1 UPS System Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-1  
15.2.2 UPS System Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-2  
15.2.3 Environmental . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-2  
15.3 Multiple Module Parallel Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3  
15.3.1 UPM Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3  
15.3.2 UPM Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3  
15.3.3 Environmental . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3  
15.3.4 Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3  
15.3.5 Module Tie Cabinet Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3  
15.3.6 Module Tie Cabinet Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-3  
Appendix A – Installation Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-1  
Warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . W-1  
®
v
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
This page intentionally left blank.  
®
vi  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
Figure 1-1. Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Cabinet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1  
Figure 2-1. Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Cabinet as Shipped on Pallet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3  
Figure 3-1. Removing Front Shipping Bracket on the Powerware 9390 UPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3  
Figure 3-2. Removing Rear Shipping Bracket on the Powerware 9390 UPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4  
Figure 5-1. REPO Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1  
Figure 6-1. Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1  
Figure 6-2. Supervisory Contact Module II TB2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Figure 7-1. Main Elements of the UPS System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1  
Figure 7-2. Path of Current Through the UPS in Normal Mode – RT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4  
Figure 7-3. Path of Current Through the UPS in Bypass Mode – RT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6  
Figure 7-4. Path of Current Through the UPS in Battery Mode – RT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8  
Figure 7-5. Path of Current through the UPMs in Normal Mode – Parallel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11  
Figure 7-6. Path of Current through the UPMs in Bypass Mode – Parallel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12  
Figure 7-7. Path of Current through the UPMs in Battery Mode – Parallel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14  
Figure 9-1. UPS Control Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1  
Figure 9-2. Parts of the LCD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2  
Figure 9-3. Main Menu and Mimic Screen (Normal Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3  
Figure 9-4. Active Events Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4  
Figure 9-5. History Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5  
Figure 9-6. Unit Output Meter Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6  
Figure 9-7. Unit Input Meter Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7  
Figure 9-8. Unit Bypass Meter Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7  
Figure 9-9. Unit Battery Meter Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8  
Figure 9-10. Unit Output Current (Load) Meter Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8  
Figure 9-11. Battery Discharge Log Summary Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9  
Figure 9-12. Battery Discharge Log Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10  
Figure 9-13. KW Demand Log Summary Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11  
Figure 9-14. KW Demand Log Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12  
Figure 9-15. Current KW Demand Log Setup Screen 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13  
Figure 9-16. Current KW Demand Log Setup Screen 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-14  
Figure 9-17. Time Interval Monitored Setup Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-15  
Figure 9-18. Time Interval Monitored Setup Save Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-16  
Figure 9-19. Maximum Level (KW) Setup Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-17  
Figure 9-20. Maximum Level (KW) Setup Save Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-18  
Figure 9-21. Maximum Current Log Summary Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-19  
Figure 9-22. Maximum Current Log Screen (Three-Phase Measurement) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20  
Figure 9-23. Maximum Current Log Screen (Individual Phase Measurement) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-21  
®
vii  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
Figure 9-24. Maximum Current Log Setup Screen 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-21  
Figure 9-25. Maximum Current Log Setup Screen 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-22  
Figure 9-26. Time Interval Monitored Setup Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-23  
Figure 9-27. Time Interval Monitored Setup Save Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24  
Figure 9-28. Maximum % of Full Load Setup Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-25  
Figure 9-29. Maximum % of Full Load Setup Save Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-26  
Figure 9-30. Calculation Method Setup Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-27  
Figure 9-31. System Meters Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-28  
Figure 9-32. Total System Output Meter Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-29  
Figure 9-33. Output Unit X Meter Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-30  
Figure 9-34. Input Unit X Meter Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-31  
Figure 9-35. Bypass Unit X Meter Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-31  
Figure 9-36. Battery Unit X Meter Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-32  
Figure 9-37. Output Current (Load) Unit X Meter Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-32  
Figure 9-38. System Setup Level 0 Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-33  
Figure 9-39. Contrast Adjust Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-34  
Figure 9-40. Versions Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-35  
Figure 9-41. Unit Type Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-35  
Figure 9-42. Enter Password Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-36  
Figure 9-43. System Setup Level 1 Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-37  
Figure 9-44. Change Password Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-38  
Figure 9-45. Change Password Save Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-39  
Figure 9-46. Time Format Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-40  
Figure 9-47. Set Date and Time MM/DD/YYYY Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-41  
Figure 9-48. Set Date and Time DD/MM/YYYY Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-42  
Figure 9-49. COM Port Setup Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-43  
Figure 9-50. COM Setup Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-44  
Figure 9-51. System Controls Screen 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-45  
Figure 9-52. System Controls Screen 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-46  
Figure 9-53. Load Off Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-47  
Figure 11-1. Remote Monitor Panel II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-2  
Figure 11-2. Relay Interface Module II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4  
Figure 11-3. Supervisory Contact Module II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5  
Figure 13-1. Optional X-Slot Cards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-2  
Figure 13-2. Sample Event History Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-5  
®
viii  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 1 Introduction  
®
The Powerware 9390 uninterruptible power supply (UPS) is a true online, continuous-duty,  
transformerless, double-conversion, solid-state, three-phase system, providing conditioned  
and uninterruptible AC power to protect the customer’s load from all nine power failures.  
The Powerware 9390 UPS is available as a single module or a multiple module parallel  
system (see paragraph 1.1).  
The Powerware online power protection system is used to prevent loss of valuable  
electronic information, minimize equipment downtime, and minimize the adverse effect on  
production equipment due to unexpected power problems.  
The Powerware 9390 UPS continually monitors incoming electrical power and removes the  
surges, spikes, sags, and other irregularities that are inherent in commercial utility power.  
Working with a building’s electrical system, the UPS system supplies clean, consistent  
power that sensitive electronic equipment requires for reliable operation. During  
brownouts, blackouts, and other power interruptions, batteries provide emergency power  
to safeguard operation.  
The UPS system is housed in a single, free-standing cabinet with safety shields behind the  
door for hazardous voltage protection. The cabinet es the battery and distribution cabinets  
in style and color and can be installed in line-up-and-match or standalone configurations.  
Figure 1-1 shows the Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA).  
Figure 1-1. Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Cabinet  
®
1-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
1.1 Basic System Configurations  
The following basic UPS system configurations are possible:  
Ī Single module UPS and one to four battery cabinets  
Ī Single module UPS with UPS Sidecar (maintenance bypass or 1+1 tie configuration) and  
one to four battery cabinets  
Ī Single module UPS, one to four battery cabinets, and an optional Integrated Distribution  
Cabinet (IDC)  
Ī Single module UPS, one to four battery cabinets, and an optional Integrated Accessory  
Cabinet (IAC) (maintenance bypass, 1+1 tie, or 1+1 tie with maintenance bypass  
configuration)  
Ī Single module UPS, one to four battery cabinets, and an optional Integrated Accessory  
Cabinet (IAC) (distribution configuration)  
Ī Powerware Hot Sync parallel system with two UPS modules, one to four battery cabinets  
for each UPS, and an optional module tie cabinet  
- One capacity/one redundant (1+1)  
- Two capacity (2+0)  
Ī Powerware Hot Sync parallel system with three UPS modules, one to four battery  
cabinets for each UPS, and an optional module tie cabinet  
- Two capacity/one redundant (2+1)  
- Three capacity (3+0)  
Ī Powerware Hot Sync parallel system with four UPS modules, one to four battery cabinets  
for each UPS, and an optional module tie cabinet  
- Three capacity/one redundant (3+1)  
- Four capacity (4+0)  
Ī Powerware Hot Sync parallel system with two UPS modules, one to four battery cabinets  
for each UPS, an optional module tie cabinet, and an optional IDC  
- One capacity/one redundant (1+1)  
- Two capacity (2+0)  
Ī Powerware Hot Sync parallel system with three UPS modules, one to four battery  
cabinets for each UPS, an optional module tie cabinet, and an optional IDC  
- Two capacity/one redundant (2+1)  
- Three capacity (3+0)  
Ī Powerware Hot Sync parallel system with four UPS modules, one to four battery cabinets  
for each UPS, an optional module tie cabinet, and an optional IDC  
- Three capacity/one redundant (3+1)  
- Four capacity (4+0)  
The UPS system configuration can be enhanced by adding optional accessories such as a  
Remote Emergency Power-off (REPO) control, Remote Monitor Panel II (RMP II), or X-Slot  
®
communication cards.  
®
1-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
1.2 Using This Manual  
This manual describes how to install and operate the Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA)  
cabinet. Read and understand the procedures described in this manual to ensure  
trouble-free installation and operation. In particular, be thoroughly familiar with the REPO  
procedure (see page 10-7).  
The information in this manual is divided into the sections and chapters listed. The system,  
options, and accessories being installed dictate which parts of this manual should be read.  
At a minimum, Chapters 1 through 3 and 8 through 10 should be examined.  
Ī Chapter 1, “Introduction” – provides a brief description of the UPS system, a  
description of the content of each chapter, text conventions used in the manual, safety  
warnings, and reference information.  
Section I, Installation  
Ī Chapter 2, “UPS Installation Plan and Unpacking” – explains how to prepare the site  
for the installation of the UPS system. It discusses equipment environmental  
requirements, inspecting, and unpacking cabinets.  
Ī Chapter 3, “Installing the UPS System” – describes how to install and wire the UPS  
cabinet and optional equipment.  
Ī Chapter 4, “Batteries” – provides battery safety and installation information.  
Ī Chapter 5, “Installing a Remote Emergency Power-off Control” – contains information  
for installing the optional REPO control.  
Ī Chapter 6, “Installing Options and Accessories” – contains information for installing an  
X-Slot Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card, parallel control wiring, an RMP II, a Relay  
Interface Module II (RIM II), or a Supervisory Contact Module II (SCM II).  
Section II, Operation  
Ī Chapter 7, “Understanding UPS Operation” – provides information on why and how a  
UPS works.  
Ī Chapter 8, “Features, Options, and Accessories” – describes the standard and optional  
UPS features and available accessories.  
Ī Chapter 9, “Using the Control Panel” – describes the controls and indicators found on  
the control panel and shows the various information screens displayed on the LCD.  
Ī Chapter 10, “UPS Operating Instructions” – contains startup and shutdown procedures  
for the UPS system.  
Ī Chapter 11, “Using Features and Options” – contains descriptions and instructions for  
the UPS system features and options.  
Ī Chapter 12, “Responding to System Events” – lists all the alarms and notices that occur  
during operation of the UPS system.  
Ī Chapter 13, “Communication” – describes the communication features of the UPS  
system.  
®
1-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Ī Chapter 14, “Maintaining the UPS System” – contains maintenance instructions for the  
UPS system.  
Ī Chapter 15, “Product Specifications” – provides detailed specifications for the UPS  
system.  
Ī Appendix A, “Installation Information” – contains important information on wiring  
requirements and recommendations, and important diagrams of the cabinets’  
mechanical details and electrical access.  
Ī Warranty – provides the Powerware warranty for this product.  
Read through each procedure before beginning the procedure. Perform only those  
procedures that apply to the UPS system being installed or operated.  
1.3 Conventions Used in This Manual  
This manual uses these type conventions:  
Ī Bold type highlights important concepts in discussions, key terms in procedures, and  
menu options, or represents a command or option that you type or enter at a prompt.  
Ī Italic type highlights notes and new terms where they are defined.  
Ī Screen type represents information that appears on the screen or LCD.  
Icon  
Description  
Information notes call attention to important features or instructions.  
[Keys] Brackets are used when referring to a specific key, such as [Enter] or [Ctrl].  
In this manual, the term UPS refers only to the UPS cabinet and its internal elements. The  
term UPS system refers to the entire power protection system – the UPS cabinet, the  
battery cabinet, and options or accessories installed.  
®
1-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
1.4 Safety Warnings  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS  
SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS  
This manual contains important instructions that should be followed during installation and  
maintenance of the UPS and batteries. Please read all instructions before operating the  
equipment and save this manual for future reference.  
The UPS cabinet is designed for industrial or computer room applications, and contains safety  
shields behind the doors. However, the UPS system is a sophisticated power system and  
should be handled with appropriate care.  
D A N G E R  
This UPS contains LETHAL VOLTAGES. All repairs and service should be performed by  
AUTHORIZED SERVICE PERSONNEL ONLY. There are NO USER SERVICEABLE PARTS inside  
the UPS.  
W A R N I N G  
Ī The UPS system contains its own energy source (batteries). The output terminals may carry  
live voltage even when the UPS is disconnected from an AC source.  
Ī To reduce the risk of fire or electric shock, install this UPS in a temperature and humidity  
controlled, indoor environment, free of conductive contaminants. Ambient temperature  
must not exceed 40°C (104°F). Do not operate near water or excessive humidity  
(95% maximum). The system is not intended for outdoor use.  
Ī Ensure all power is disconnected before performing installation or service.  
C A U T I O N  
Ī Batteries can present a risk of electrical shock or burn from high short-circuit current.  
Observe proper precautions. Servicing should be performed by qualified service personnel  
knowledgeable of batteries and required precautions. Keep unauthorized personnel away  
from batteries.  
Ī Proper disposal of batteries is required. Refer to local codes for disposal requirements.  
Ī Never dispose of batteries in a fire. Batteries may explode when exposed to flame.  
Ī Keep the UPS doors closed to ensure proper cooling airflow and to protect personnel from  
dangerous voltages inside the unit.  
Ī Do not operate the UPS system close to gas or electric heat sources.  
Ī The operating environment should be maintained within the parameters stated in this  
manual.  
Ī Keep surroundings uncluttered, clean, and free from excess moisture.  
Ī Observe all DANGER, CAUTION, and WARNING notices affixed to the inside and outside of  
the equipment.  
®
1-5  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
1.5 For More Information  
Refer to the Powerware 9390 Integrated Battery Cabinet (Models IBC-S and IBC-L)  
Installation Manual (164201536) for the following additional information:  
Ī Integrated Battery Cabinet (IBC) installation instructions, including site preparation,  
planning for installation, wiring, and safety information.  
Ī Detailed illustrations of the cabinet, including dimension and connection point drawings.  
Refer to the Powerware 9390 Integrated Distribution Cabinet (160 kVA) Installation and  
Operation Manual, (164201560), the Powerware 9390 Integrated Accessory Cabinet (IAC-B  
and IAC-T Configurations) Installation and Operation Manual (164201590), the Powerware  
9390 Integrated Accessory Cabinet (IAC-D Configuration) Installation and Operation Manual  
(164201591), the Powerware 9390 UPS Sidecar Installation and Operation Manual  
(164201586), or the Powerware 9390 Sync Control Installation and Operation Manual  
(164201571), as applicable, for the following additional information:  
Ī Installation instructions, including site preparation, planning for installation, and wiring  
and safety information. Detailed illustrations of the cabinet with dimensional and  
connection point drawings are provided.  
Ī Operation, including controls, functions of the standard and optional features,  
procedures for using with the UPS, and information about maintenance.  
Visit www.powerware.com or contact your Eaton service representative for information on  
how to obtain copies of these manuals  
1.6 Getting Help  
If help is needed with any of the following:  
Ī Scheduling initial startup  
Ī Regional locations and telephone numbers  
Ī A question about any of the information in this manual  
Ī A question this manual does not answer  
Please call the Eaton Help Desk for Powerware products at:  
In the United States 1-800-843-9433 or 1-919-870-3028  
In Canada  
1-800-461-9166  
All other countries Call your service representative  
®
1-6  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section I Installation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This page intentionally left blank.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 2 UPS Installation Plan and Unpacking  
Use the following basic sequence of steps to install the UPS:  
1. Create an installation plan for the UPS system (Chapter 2).  
2. Prepare your site for the UPS system (Chapter 2).  
3. Inspect and unpack the UPS cabinet (Chapter 2).  
4. Unload and install the UPS cabinet, and wire the system (Chapter 3).  
5. Install features, accessories, or options, as applicable (Chapters 5 and 6).  
6. Complete the Installation Checklist (Chapter 3).  
7. Have authorized service personnel perform preliminary operational checks and  
startup.  
NOTE Startup and operational checks must be performed by an authorized Eaton  
Customer Service Engineer, or the warranty terms specified on page W-1 become void.  
This service is offered as part of the sales contract for the UPS. Contact service in  
advance (usually a two-week notice is required) to reserve a preferred startup date.  
2.1 Creating an Installation Plan  
Before installing the UPS system, read and understand how this manual applies to the  
system being installed. Use the procedures and illustrations in the following chapters to  
create a logical plan for installing the system.  
2.2 Preparing the Site  
For the UPS system to operate at peak efficiency, the installation site should meet the  
environmental parameters outlined in this manual. If the UPS is to be operated at an  
altitude higher than 1500m (5000 ft), contact your Eaton service representative for  
important information about high altitude operation. The operating environment must  
meet the weight, clearance, and environmental requirements specified in Drawing  
164201604-2 on page A-3 and size requirements specified on Drawing 164201604-9  
starting on page A-46.  
The UPS cabinets use forced air cooling to regulate internal component temperature. Air  
inlets are in the front of the cabinet and outlets are in the top. You must allow clearance in  
front of and above each cabinet for proper air circulation.  
®
2-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Installation Plan and Unpacking  
2.2.1 Environmental Considerations  
The life of the UPS system is adversely affected if the installation does not meet the  
following guidelines:  
Ī The system must be installed on a level floor suitable for computer or electronic  
equipment.  
Ī The system must be installed in a temperature and humidity controlled indoor area free  
of conductive contaminants.  
Failure to follow guidelines may void your warranty.  
2.2.2 Preparing for Wiring the UPS System  
NOTE If installing, as part of the UPS system, a maintenance bypass without a rectifier  
input breaker, a minimum of two separate feeds with upstream feeder breakers, or one  
feed with two upstream feeder breakers, must be provided: one for the UPS and one for  
the maintenance bypass input. DO NOT use one feed or a single feeder breaker to  
supply both the UPS and the maintenance bypass.  
For external wiring requirements, including the minimum AWG size of external wiring, see  
Table E through Table G starting on page A-12. The power wiring connections for this  
equipment are rated at 90°C. If wire is run in an ambient temperature greater than 30°C,  
higher temperature wire and/or larger size wire may be necessary  
Control wiring for Emergency Power-off (EPO) and optional accessories (such as building  
alarms and monitoring interface) should be connected at the customer interface terminal  
blocks located inside the UPS.  
LAN and telephone drops, for use with X-Slot connectivity cards, must be supplied by  
facility planners or the customer.  
®
2-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Installation Plan and Unpacking  
2.3 Inspecting and Unpacking the UPS Cabinet  
The cabinet is shipped bolted to a wooden pallet and protected with outer protective  
packaging material (see Figure 2-1).  
Figure 2-1. Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Cabinet as Shipped on Pallet  
C A U T I O N  
The UPS cabinet is heavy (see Table A on page A-3). If unpacking instructions are not closely  
followed, the cabinet may tip and cause serious injury.  
®
2-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Installation Plan and Unpacking  
1. Carefully inspect the outer packaging for evidence of damage during transit.  
C A U T I O N  
Do not install a damaged cabinet. Report any damage to the carrier and contact your Eaton  
service representative immediately.  
2. Use a forklift or pallet jack to move the packaged cabinet to the installation site,  
or as close as possible, before unpacking. Insert the forklift or pallet jack forks  
between the pallet supports on the bottom of the unit.  
NOTE Verify that the forklift or pallet jack is rated to handle the weight of the cabinet  
(see Table A on page A-3 for cabinet weight).  
C A U T I O N  
Do not tilt the UPS cabinet more than 10° from vertical or the cabinet may tip over.  
3. Set the pallet on a firm, level surface, allowing a minimum clearance of 3m (10 ft)  
on each side for removing the cabinet from the pallet.  
NOTE The UPS cabinet is shipped with a debris shield covering the ventilation grill on  
top of the unit. Do not remove the debris shield until installation is complete.  
4. Remove the protective covering from the cabinet.  
5. Remove the packing material, and discard or recycle in a responsible manner.  
6. After removing the protective covering, inspect the contents for any evidence of  
physical damage, and compare each item with the Bill of Lading. If damage has  
occurred or shortages are evident, contact your Eaton service representative  
immediately to determine the extent of the damage and its impact upon further  
installation.  
NOTE While waiting for installation, protect the unpacked cabinet from moisture, dust,  
and other harmful contaminants. Failure to store and protect the UPS properly may  
void your warranty.  
®
2-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 3 Installing the UPS System  
3.1 Preliminary Installation Information  
W A R N I N G  
Installation should be performed only by qualified personnel.  
Refer to the following while installing the UPS system:  
Ī Appendix A contains installation drawings and additional installation notes.  
Ī Dimensions are in millimeters and inches.  
Ī Do not tilt the cabinets more than 10° during installation.  
Ī The conduit landing plates are to be removed to add conduit landing holes as required.  
Plate material is 16 gauge steel (1.5 mm/0.06thick).  
Ī The cabinets must be installed on a level floor suitable for computer or electronic  
equipment.  
Ī If perforated floor tiles are required for ventilation, place them in front of the UPS. See  
Table A on page A-3 for equipment weight and point loading.  
Ī Details about control wiring are provided in each procedure for connecting options and  
features. Drawing 164201604-8 and Table R through Table X starting on page A-33  
identify the control wiring terminations.  
3.2 UPS Cabinet Installation  
To install a UPS cabinet, perform the procedures in the following paragraphs.  
NOTE When a line-up-and-match UPS system is ordered together with battery cabinets,  
the first battery cabinet is supplied with two cosmetic covers. The UPS cabinet,  
additional battery cabinets, and other ancillary cabinets are supplied without cosmetic  
covers.  
NOTE When a UPS system is ordered together with battery cabinets for standalone  
installation, the first battery cabinet is supplied with two cosmetic covers. Additional  
battery cabinets are supplied without cosmetic covers. Cosmetic covers must be ordered  
for the UPS cabinet and/or other ancillary cabinets.  
®
3-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
3.2.1 Unloading the Powerware 9390 UPS Cabinet from the Pallet  
The UPS cabinet is bolted to a wooden pallet supported by wood skids. To remove the  
pallet, perform the following procedure:  
W A R N I N G  
The UPS cabinet is heavy. See Table A on page A-3 for weight of cabinets. If unloading  
instructions are not closely followed, the cabinet may cause serious injury.  
C A U T I O N  
Do not tilt cabinets more than 10° from vertical.  
1. If not already accomplished, use a forklift or pallet jack to move the cabinet to the  
installation area, or as close as possible, before unloading from the pallet. Insert  
the forklift or pallet jack forks between the skids on the bottom of the unit.  
NOTE Verify that the forklift or pallet jack is rated to handle the weight of the cabinet  
(see Table A on page A-3 for cabinet weight).  
2. Unfasten the front door latch and swing the door open (see Figure 3-1).  
3. Remove the doors. Remove the retaining screws located inside each door at the  
top and bottom hinge pivot points, then lift the door off. Retain the hardware for  
later use.  
4. If the leveling feet are not fully retracted, turn the leveling feet until they are  
retracted.  
5. Remove the four bolts securing the front shipping bracket to the cabinet and four  
bolts securing the bracket to the pallet (see Figure 3-1). Remove the front shipping  
bracket. If installing the cabinet permanently, retain the shipping bracket and  
securing hardware for later use.  
6. Remove the four bolts securing the rear shipping bracket to the pallet. Do NOT  
remove the four bolts securing the bracket to the cabinet (see Figure 3-2 on  
page 3-4).  
7. Remove the four bolts securing the removable skid and remove the skid (see  
Figure 3-1).  
®
3-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
Front View  
Vented Front Doors  
Skid Bolts  
Shipping  
Bracket Bolts  
Pallet  
Shipping  
Bracket Bolts  
Removable Skid  
Front Shipping Bracket  
Figure 3-1. Removing Front Shipping Bracket on the Powerware 9390 UPS  
®
3-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
Rear View  
Shipping  
Bracket Bolts  
Pallet  
Shipping  
Bracket Bolts  
Rear Shipping Bracket  
Figure 3-2. Removing Rear Shipping Bracket on the Powerware 9390 UPS  
®
3-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
NOTE In the following step the pallet tilts and acts as a ramp once the cabinet is rolled  
beyond the the center of the pallet. Be sure to restrain the cabinet as it continues to roll  
down the pallet/ramp. The rear shipping bracket will act as a brake to assist  
restraining the cabinet.  
W A R N I N G  
Do not stand directly in front of the pallet while unloading the cabinet. If unloading  
instructions are not closely followed, the cabinet may cause serious injury.  
8. Slowly roll the cabinet toward the front of the pallet. Once the pallet tilts,  
continue rolling the cabinet down the pallet until the cabinet is clear of the pallet.  
9. Remove the four bolts securing the rear shipping bracket to the cabinet (see  
Figure 3-2). If installing the cabinet permanently, retain the shipping bracket and  
securing hardware for later use.  
10. Roll the cabinet to the final installation location.  
11. If installing the cabinet permanently, retain the shipping brackets and hardware;  
otherwise, discard or recycle the pallet and shipping brackets in a responsible  
manner.  
12. If permanently mounting the system, proceed to Step 15; otherwise, continue to  
Step 13.  
13. Secure the UPS cabinet in position by lowering the leveling feet until the cabinet is  
not resting on the casters and the cabinet is level.  
14. If installing battery and distribution cabinets, proceed to paragraphs 3.2.2 and  
3.2.3; otherwise, proceed to paragraph 3.2.6.  
15. Using the retained hardware, reinstall the shipping brackets removed in Step 6 to  
the front and rear of the UPS cabinet with the angle facing outward (see  
Figure 3-1 and Figure 3-2).  
16. Secure the cabinet to the floor with contractor-supplied hardware.  
17. If installing battery and distribution cabinets, proceed to paragraphs 3.2.2 and  
3.2.3; otherwise, proceed to paragraph 3.2.6.  
3.2.2 Battery Cabinet Installation  
To install the battery cabinet, refer to the Powerware 9390 Integrated Battery Cabinet  
(Models IBC-S and IBC-L) Installation Manual. After the battery cabinet is installed, return  
to paragraph 3.2.6 to wire the UPS and battery cabinet.  
®
3-5  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
3.2.3 Integrated Distribution Cabinet Installation  
To install and wire an IDC, refer to the Powerware 9390 Integrated Distribution Cabinet  
(160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual. After the IDC is installed and wired, return to  
paragraph 3.2.6 to complete the UPS cabinet wiring.  
3.2.4 Integrated Accessory Cabinet Installation  
To install and wire an IAC, refer to the Powerware 9390 Integrated Accessory Cabinet (IAC-B  
and IAC-T Configurations) Installation and Operation Manual or the Powerware 9390  
Integrated Accessory Cabinet (IAC-D Configuration) Installation and Operation Manual.  
After the IAC is installed and wired, return to paragraph 3.2.6 to complete the UPS cabinet  
wiring.  
3.2.5 UPS Sidecar Wiring  
To wire an UPS Sidecar, refer to the Powerware 9390 UPS Sidecar Installation and  
Operation Manual. After the UPS Sidecar is wired, return to paragraph 3.2.6 to complete  
the UPS cabinet wiring.  
3.2.6 Installing UPS External and Battery Power Wiring  
NOTE The UPS cabinet is shipped with a debris shield covering the ventilation grill on  
top of the unit. Do not remove the debris shield until installation is complete. However,  
remove the shield before operating the UPS. Once the debris shield is removed, do not  
place objects on the ventilation grill.  
NOTE Remove the UPS cabinet top or bottom conduit landing plate to drill or punch  
conduit holes (see Drawing 164201604-6 on page A-27).  
NOTE If the load requires a neutral, a bypass source neutral must be provided. If the  
load does not require a neutral and there is no neutral conductor connected at the  
bypass input, a neutral to ground bonding jumper must be installed. DO NOT install  
both a source neutral and a bonding jumper. See Table E through Table G or Table O  
through Table Q for neutral bonding jumper wire sizes. Bonding jumper must be  
copper wire.  
C A U T I O N  
HIGH IMPEDANCE GROUND SOURCES - If the supply source is a high impedance ground (IT)  
type, the input neutral conductor must be connected from the source of supply. If there is no  
output neutral connected to the UPS, the neutral-forming transformer kit (PN 103005400) may  
be used instead of pulling a neutral from the source. If the load requires a neutral, then an  
input neutral conductor must be pulled into the UPS. In no circumstances shall a neutral to  
ground bonding jumper be installed in the UPS.  
®
3-6  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
C A U T I O N  
DELTA SOURCES (TN-S) - The 9390 UPS system can be operated only from a delta supply  
source that is fully floating and if the neutral-forming transformer kit (PN 103005400) is  
installed in the UPS. The UPS cannot be operated from a mid-point or end-point grounded  
delta supply source. With this type of supply source, there is no capability to provide an output  
neutral. In no circumstances shall a neutral to ground bonding jumper be installed in the  
UPS.  
Use the applicable procedure from the following list for the UPS model being installed:  
Ī For UPS models 120/100, 120/120, 160/100, 160/120, and 160/160 with 208V/220V input  
and UPS models 160/100, 160/120, and 160/160 with 480V input, proceed to  
paragraph 3.2.6.1.  
Ī For UPS models 120/100 and 120/120 with 480V input, proceed to paragraph 3.2.6.2.  
3.2.6.1 External Wiring Installation Procedure A  
To install wiring to connections:  
1. Slide the air filters up and remove them from the cabinet.  
2. Remove the screws securing the control panel door and swing the door open.  
3. Remove the screws securing the bottom internal safety shield panel and remove  
the panel to gain access to the input, output, and battery terminals. Retain the  
hardware for later use.  
4. If installing power wiring from the top of the cabinet, proceed to Step 5;  
otherwise, proceed to Step 6.  
5. Remove the screws securing the top and right side internal safety shield panels  
and remove the panels to gain access to the top wiring entry. Retain the hardware  
for later use.  
6. Route the input and output cables to the UPS terminal blocks. See Drawing  
164201604-7 starting on page A-29 for wiring access information and terminal  
locations.  
7. If wiring a single-feed system, proceed to Step 8; if wiring a dual-feed system,  
proceed to Step 10.  
8. Connect phase A, B, C, and Neutral (if required) input power wiring from the  
utility source to the rectifier input terminals and neutral terminals in the UPS  
cabinet. See Appendix A for wiring and termination requirements and wiring  
access information. Note wiring connections for single-feed systems.  
9. Proceed to Step 13.  
®
3-7  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
C A U T I O N  
In the following step, DO NOT move the sensing and EMI wires from the rectifier contactor K1  
input terminals. These wires must remain connected to the K1 terminals for proper UPS  
operation.  
10. Disconnect the phase A, B, and C bypass contactor K5 power input leads only (two  
wires per phase) from the rectifier contactor K1 input terminals. Connect these  
power leads to the bypass input terminals.  
11. Connect phase A, B, and C rectifier input power wiring from the utility source to  
the rectifier input terminals in the UPS cabinet. See Appendix A for wiring and  
termination requirements and wiring access information. Note wiring connections  
for dual-feed systems.  
12. Connect phase A, B, and C, and Neutral (if required) bypass input power wiring  
from the utility source to the bypass input terminals and neutral terminals in the  
UPS cabinet. See Appendix A for wiring and termination requirements and wiring  
access information. Note wiring connections for dual-feed systems.  
13. If wiring an IDC or IAC, proceed to Step 14; otherwise, proceed to Step 17.  
14. Route and connect the output cable between the UPS cabinet and the IDC or IAC.  
Refer to the applicable IDC or IAC installation and operation manual, referenced in  
paragraph 1.5 on page 1-6, for wiring instructions. See Appendix A for UPS cabinet  
wiring access information.  
15. Connect phase A, B, and C, and Neutral (if required) power wiring from the IDC or  
IAC to the UPS cabinet output and neutral terminals. See Appendix A for wiring  
and termination requirements.  
16. Proceed to paragraph 3.2.6.3.  
17. If wiring a parallel system, proceed to Step 18; otherwise, proceed to Step 20.  
C A U T I O N  
Parallel system wiring length should be in accordance with Drawing 164201604-5, sheet  
15 of 15, to ensure approximately equal current sharing when in Static Bypass mode.  
18. Connect phase A, B, and C, and Neutral (if required) power wiring from the output  
and neutral terminals of each uninterruptible power module (UPM) to the module  
tie cabinet. See Appendix A for UPM wiring and termination requirements and  
wiring access information.  
19. Proceed to paragraph 3.2.6.3.  
20. Connect phase A, B, and C, and Neutral (if required) power wiring from the output  
and neutral terminals to the critical load. See Appendix A for wiring and  
termination requirements and wiring access information.  
21. Proceed to paragraph 3.2.6.3.  
®
3-8  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
3.2.6.2 External Wiring Installation Procedure B  
To install wiring to connections:  
1. Slide the air filters up and remove them from the cabinet.  
2. Remove the screws securing the control panel door and swing the door open.  
Retain the hardware for later use.  
3. Remove the screws securing the bottom internal safety shield panel and remove  
the panel to gain access to the input, output, and battery terminals. Retain the  
hardware for later use.  
4. If installing power wiring from the top of the cabinet, proceed to Step 5;  
otherwise, proceed to Step 6.  
5. Remove the screws securing the top and right side internal safety shield panels  
and remove the panels to gain access to the top wiring entry. Retain the hardware  
for later use.  
6. Route the input and output cables to the UPS terminal blocks. See Drawing  
164201604-7 starting on page A-29 for wiring access information and terminal  
locations.  
7. If wiring a single-feed system, proceed to Step 8; if wiring a dual-feed system,  
proceed to Step 10.  
8. Connect phase A, B, C, and Neutral (if required) input power wiring from the  
utility source to the rectifier input terminals and neutral terminals in the UPS  
cabinet. See Appendix A for wiring and termination requirements and wiring  
access information. Note the wiring connections for single-feed systems.  
9. Proceed to Step 13.  
10. Disconnect the single-feed jumpers from the phase A, B, and C terminals on the  
rectifier input terminals and bypass input terminals. Remove the jumpers from the  
cabinet.  
11. Connect phase A, B, and C rectifier input power wiring from the utility source to  
the rectifier input terminals in the UPS cabinet. See Appendix A for wiring and  
termination requirements and wiring access information. Note the wiring  
connections for dual-feed systems.  
12. Connect phase A, B, and C, and Neutral (if required) bypass input power wiring  
from the utility source to the bypass input terminals and neutral terminals in the  
UPS cabinet. See Appendix A for wiring and termination requirements and wiring  
access information. Note the wiring connections for dual-feed systems.  
13. If wiring an IDC or IAC, proceed to Step 14; otherwise, proceed to Step 17.  
®
3-9  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
14. Route and connect the output cable between the UPS cabinet and the IDC or IAC.  
Refer to the applicable IDC or IAC installation and operation manual, referenced in  
paragraph 1.5 on page 1-6, for wiring instructions. See Appendix A for UPS cabinet  
wiring access information.  
15. Connect phase A, B, and C, and Neutral (if required) power wiring from the IDC or  
IAC to the UPS cabinet output and neutral terminals. See Appendix A for wiring  
and termination requirements.  
16. Proceed to paragraph 3.2.6.3.  
17. If wiring a parallel system, proceed to Step 18; otherwise, proceed to Step 20.  
C A U T I O N  
Parallel system wiring length should be in accordance with Drawing 164201604-5, sheet  
15 of 15, to ensure approximately equal current sharing when in static bypass mode.  
18. Connect phase A, B, and C, and Neutral (if required) power wiring from the output  
and neutral terminals of each uninterruptible power module (UPM) to the module  
tie cabinet. See Appendix A for UPM wiring and termination requirements and  
wiring access information.  
19. Proceed to paragraph 3.2.6.3.  
20. Connect phase A, B, and C, and Neutral (if required) power wiring from output  
terminals and neutral terminals to the critical load. See Appendix A for wiring and  
termination requirements and wiring access information.  
21. Proceed to paragraph 3.2.6.3.  
3.2.6.3 Battery Wiring  
C A U T I O N  
When sizing the battery system, do not exceed the internal battery charger capabilities. See  
Chapter 15, “Product Specifications,” for maximum battery charger currents.  
To install wiring to connections:  
1. Route and connect the battery cables between the UPS and battery cabinets in  
accordance with the instructions in the Powerware 9390 Integrated Battery Cabinet  
(Models IBC-S and IBC-L) Installation Manual. See Appendix A for UPS cabinet  
wiring access information.  
2. Connect the positive, negative, and ground DC power wiring from the battery  
cabinet to the UPS cabinet battery terminal block and ground terminals. See  
Appendix A for wiring and termination requirements.  
3. After wiring the UPS system to the facility power and critical load, be sure to  
ground the system according to local and/or national electrical wiring codes.  
®
3-10  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
4. If wiring interface connections, proceed to paragraph 3.2.7; otherwise, proceed to  
Step 5.  
5. When all wiring is complete, reinstall the safety shield panels removed in previous  
steps. Secure with the retained hardware.  
6. Close the control panel door and secure with the retained hardware.  
7. Reinstall the doors removed in paragraph 3.2.1 and secure with the retained  
hardware.  
8. Close the doors and secure the latch.  
3.2.7 Installing Interface Connections  
3.2.7.1 TB1 and TB2 Connections  
NOTE When installing interface wiring for TB1 and TB2 connections, conduit must be  
installed between each device and the UPS cabinet.  
To install wiring to connections:  
1. Verify the UPS system is turned off and all power sources are removed. See  
Chapter 10, “UPS Operating Instructions,” for shutdown instructions.  
2. If not already open, unfasten the front door latch and swing the door open.  
3. If not already removed, remove the doors. Remove the retaining screws located  
inside each door at the top and bottom hinge pivot points, then lift the door off.  
Retain the hardware for later use.  
4. Remove the screws securing the control panel door and swing the door open.  
Retain the hardware for later use.  
5. Remove the screws securing the top internal safety shield panel. Remove the panel  
to gain access to the TB1 and TB2 terminal blocks and the top conduit landing  
plate (see Drawing 164201604-8 starting on page A-33). Retain the hardware for  
later use.  
6. If installing interface wiring from the bottom of the cabinet, proceed to Step 7;  
otherwise, proceed to Step 8.  
7. Remove the screws securing the right side and bottom internal safety shield panels  
and remove the panels to gain access to the bottom conduit landing plate.  
8. Remove the UPS cabinet top or bottom conduit landing plate to drill or punch  
conduit holes (see Drawing 164201604-6 on page A-27).  
9. Reinstall the conduit landing plate and install the conduit.  
10. To locate the appropriate terminals and review the wiring and termination  
requirements, see Drawing 164201604-8 starting on page A-33.  
®
3-11  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
11. Route and connect the wiring.  
12. If wiring TB2 battery cabinet interface connections, proceed to paragraph 3.2.7.2; if  
wiring the X-Slot connections only, proceed to paragraph 3.2.7.3; otherwise,  
proceed to Step 13.  
13. When all wiring is complete, reinstall the safety shield panels removed in previous  
steps. Secure with the retained hardware.  
14. Close the control panel door and secure with the retained hardware.  
15. Reinstall the doors and secure with the retained hardware.  
16. Close the doors and secure the latch.  
3.2.7.2 TB2 Battery Cabinet Connections  
To install wiring to connections:  
1. Verify the UPS system is turned off and all power sources are removed. See  
Chapter 10, “UPS Operating Instructions,” for shutdown instructions.  
2. If not already open, unfasten the front door latch and swing the door open.  
3. If not already removed, remove the doors. Remove the retaining screws located  
inside each door at the top and bottom hinge pivot points, then lift the door off.  
Retain the hardware for later use.  
4. Remove the screws securing the control panel door and swing the door open.  
Retain the hardware for later use.  
5. Remove the screws securing the top internal safety shield panel. Remove the panel  
to gain access to the TB2 terminal block (see Drawing 164201604-8 starting on  
page A-33). Retain the hardware for later use.  
6. To locate the appropriate terminals and review the wiring and termination  
requirements, see Drawing 164201604-8 starting on page A-33.  
7. If battery cabinets are installed attached to the UPS cabinet, proceed to Step 8; if  
battery cabinets are installed separated from the UPS cabinet, proceed to Step 11.  
8. Route the UV trip and Aux wiring harness supplied with the battery cabinet from  
the battery cabinet to the UPS cabinet. Refer to Appendix A and to the Powerware  
9390 Integrated Battery Cabinet (Models IBC-S and IBC-L) Installation Manual for  
wiring access information.  
9. Connect the wiring to TB2 terminals.  
10. Proceed to Step 17.  
11. If installing interface wiring from the bottom of the cabinet, proceed to Step 12;  
otherwise, proceed to Step 13.  
®
3-12  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
12. Remove the screws securing the bottom and right side internal safety shield panels  
and remove the panels to gain access to the bottom conduit landing plate.  
NOTE When installing UV trip and Aux battery interface wiring to the UPS interface  
terminals, conduit must be installed between the UPS and battery cabinets.  
13. Remove the UPS cabinet top or bottom conduit landing plate to drill or punch  
conduit holes (see Drawing 164201604-6 on page A-27).  
14. Reinstall the conduit landing plate and install the conduit.  
15. Route the UV trip and Aux wiring from the battery cabinet to the UPS.  
16. Connect the wiring to the TB2 terminals.  
17. If wiring X-Slot connections, proceed to paragraph 3.2.7.3; otherwise, proceed to  
Step 18.  
18. When all wiring is complete, reinstall the safety shield panels removed in previous  
steps. Secure with the retained hardware.  
19. Close the control panel door and secure with the retained hardware.  
20. Reinstall the doors removed previously and secure with the retained hardware.  
21. Close the doors and secure the latch.  
3.2.7.3 X-Slot Connections  
NOTE LAN and telephone drops for use with X-Slot connectivity cards must be provided  
by facility planners or the customer.  
NOTE When installing external wiring to X-Slot cards, conduit must be installed to the  
UPS cabinet. When installing internal wiring to X-Slot terminals, route the wiring  
through the internal opening in the X-Slot communication bay.  
For installation and setup of an X-Slot card, please contact Powerware (see page 1-6).  
To install wiring to connections:  
1. If not already installed, install the LAN and telephone drops.  
2. Unfasten the front door latch and swing the door open.  
3. Remove the UPS cabinet X-Slot conduit landing plate to drill or punch conduit  
holes (see Drawing 164201604-6 on page A-27).  
4. Reinstall the conduit landing plate and install the conduit.  
5. Route and install the LAN, telephone, and other cables to the appropriate X-Slot  
cards.  
®
3-13  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
6. When all wiring is complete, reinstall the safety shield panels removed in previous  
steps. Secure with the retained hardware.  
7. Close the control panel door and secure with the retained hardware.  
8. Reinstall the doors removed previously and secure with the retained hardware.  
9. Close the doors and secure the latch.  
10. Refer to the manual supplied with the X-Slot card for operator instructions.  
3.2.8 Installing Accessories and Parallel System Control Wiring  
To install an optional Remote Emergency Power-off Control, see Chapter 5, “Installing a  
Remote Emergency Power-off Control.” To install optional accessories, see Chapter 6,  
“Installing Options and Accessories.” To install parallel system control wiring, see Chapter 6,  
“Installing Options and Accessories.”  
3.3 Initial Startup  
Startup and operational checks must be performed by an authorized Eaton Customer  
Service Engineer, or the warranty terms specified on page W-1 become void. This service is  
offered as part of the sales contract for the UPS. Contact service in advance (usually a  
two-week notice is required) to reserve a preferred startup date.  
3.4 Completing the Installation Checklist  
The final step in installing the UPS system is completing the following Installation Checklist.  
This checklist ensures that you have completely installed all hardware, cables, and other  
equipment. Complete all items listed on the checklist to ensure a smooth installation. Make  
a copy of the Installation Checklist before filling it out, and retain the original. If installing a  
parallel system, complete the Parallel System Installation Checklist in addition to the  
Installation Checklist.  
After the installation is complete, your Eaton service representative must verify the  
operation of the UPS system and commission it to support the critical load. The service  
representative cannot perform any installation tasks other than verifying software and  
operating setup parameters. Service personnel may request a copy of the completed  
Installation Checklist to verify all applicable equipment installations have been completed.  
NOTE The Installation Checklist MUST be completed prior to starting the UPS system  
for the first time.  
®
3-14  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
Installation Checklist  
- All packing materials and restraints have been removed from each cabinet.  
- Each cabinet in the UPS system is placed in its installed location.  
- The front shipping bracket is installed and adjusted, if the cabinet is not installed permanently.  
- A cabinet grounding/mounting kit is installed between any cabinets that are bolted together.  
- All conduits and cables are properly routed to the UPS and any ancillary cabinets.  
- All power cables are properly sized and terminated.  
- Neutral conductors are installed or bonded to ground as per requirements.  
- Battery cables are terminated on E4 (+) and E5 (-).  
- Battery UV trip and Aux contact signal wiring is connected from the UPS to the battery breaker.  
- LAN and telephone drops are installed.  
- All telephone and LAN connections have been completed.  
- A ground conductor is properly installed.  
- Air conditioning equipment is installed and operating correctly.  
- The area around the installed UPS system is clean and dust-free. (It is recommended that the UPS be  
installed on a level floor suitable for computer or electronic equipment.)  
- Adequate workspace exists around the UPS and other cabinets.  
- Adequate lighting is provided around all UPS equipment.  
- A 120 Vac service outlet is located within 7.5 meters (25 feet) of the UPS equipment.  
- The REPO device is mounted in its installed location and its wiring is terminated inside the UPS cabinet.  
The REPO switch must be a latching-type switch with a dedicated circuit.  
- The normally-closed (NC) Emergency Power-off contact (pins 1 and 2 on TB1) is jumpered if not used.  
- Alarm relays and building alarms are wired appropriately. (OPTIONAL)  
- A remote battery disconnect control is mounted in its installed location and its wiring is terminated inside  
the UPS and battery cabinet. (OPTIONAL)  
- Accessories are mounted in installed locations and wiring is terminated inside the UPS cabinet.  
(OPTIONAL)  
- The debris shield covering the UPS cabinet ventilation grill is removed.  
- Startup and operational checks are performed by an authorized Eaton Customer Service Engineer.  
®
3-15  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
Parallel System Installation Checklist  
- Each cabinet in the parallel system is placed in its installed location.  
- All conduits and cables are properly routed to the UPMs and to the parallel tie or distribution cabinet.  
- All power cables are properly sized and terminated.  
- The bypass source feeding the optional bypass of the parallel tie cabinet and the UPMs is from the same  
source of supply and is a four-wire wye configuration.  
- Neutral conductors are installed or bonded to ground as per requirements.  
- A ground conductor is properly installed.  
- Computer Area Network (CAN) wiring between the UPMs is properly installed.  
- Pull chain wiring between the UPMs is properly installed.  
- Adequate workspace exists around the UPMs, parallel tie cabinet, and other cabinets.  
- Startup and operational checks are performed by an authorized Eaton Customer Service Engineer.  
®
3-16  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
Notes  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
_________________________________________________________________________  
®
3-17  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the UPS System  
This page intentionally left blank.  
®
3-18  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4 Batteries  
4.1 Important Safety Instructions  
This chapter describes installing the UPS batteries.  
C A U T I O N  
Only qualified service personnel (such as a licensed electrician) should perform the battery  
installation. Risk of electrical shock.  
NOTE DO NOT DISCONNECT the batteries while the UPS is in Battery mode.  
Consider all warnings, cautions, and notes before installing or replacing batteries.  
W A R N I N G  
Ī Batteries can present a risk of electrical shock or burn from high short-circuit current. The  
following precautions should be observed: 1) Remove watches, rings, or other metal  
objects; 2) Use tools with insulated handles; 3) Do not lay tools or metal parts on top of  
batteries; 4) Wear rubber globes and boots.  
Ī ELECTRIC ENERGY HAZARD. Do not attempt to alter any battery wiring or connectors.  
Attempting to alter wiring can cause injury.  
C A U T I O N  
Ī The installation of batteries should be performed by qualified service personnel  
knowledgeable of batteries and required precautions. Keep unauthorized personnel away  
from batteries.  
Ī Replace batteries with the same number and type of batteries as originally installed in the  
UPS.  
Ī Disconnect the charging source prior to connecting or disconnecting terminals.  
Ī Determine if the battery is inadvertently grounded. If it is, remove the source of the  
ground. Contacting any part of a grounded battery can cause a risk of electric shock. An  
electric shock is less likely if you disconnect the grounding connection before you work on  
the batteries.  
Ī Proper disposal of batteries is required. Refer to your local codes for disposal requirements.  
Ī Never dispose of batteries in a fire. Batteries may explode when exposed to flame.  
®
4-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Batteries  
A V E R T I S S E M E N T !  
Ī Les batteries peuvent présenter un risque de décharge électrique ou de brûlure par des  
courts-circuits de haute intensité. Prendre les précautions nécessaires.  
Ī Pour le replacement, utiliser le même nombre et modéle des batteries.  
A T T E N T I O N !  
Ī Une mise au rebut réglementaire des batteries est obligatoire. Consulter les règlements en  
vigueur dans votre localité.  
Ī Ne jamais jeter les batteries au feu. L’exposition aux flammes risque de les faire exploser.  
4.2 Installing Batteries  
NOTE There is no DC disconnect device within the UPS.  
Install batteries in accordance with the battery and battery rack manufacturer’s  
instructions.  
4.3 Recycling the Used Battery or UPS  
Contact your local recycling or hazardous waste center for information on proper disposal  
of the used battery or UPS.  
W A R N I N G  
Ī Do not dispose of the battery or batteries in a fire. Batteries may explode. Proper disposal  
of batteries is required. Refer to your local codes for disposal requirements.  
Ī Do not open or mutilate the battery or batteries. Released electrolyte is harmful to the skin  
and eyes. It may be toxic.  
C A U T I O N  
Do not discard the UPS or the UPS batteries in the trash. This product contains sealed,  
lead-acid batteries and must be disposed of properly. For more information, contact your local  
recycling/reuse or hazardous waste center.  
C A U T I O N  
Do not discard waste electrical or electronic equipment (WEEE) in the trash. For proper  
disposal, contact your local recycling/reuse or hazardous waste center.  
®
4-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5 Installing a Remote Emergency Power-off Switch  
A latching-type REPO switch can be used in an emergency to shut down the UPS and  
remove power to the critical load from a location away from where the UPS is installed.  
Figure 5-1 shows a REPO switch.  
UNINTERRUPTIBLE POWER SYSTEM  
EMERGENCY OFF  
To UPS  
To Other Equipment  
Figure 5-1. REPO Switch  
NOTE When installing the REPO switch, you must install conduit between the device  
and the UPS cabinet for wiring the switch.  
NOTE Remove the UPS cabinet top or bottom conduit landing plate to punch conduit  
holes (see Drawing 164201604-6 on page A-27).  
NOTE The REPO switch must be a latching-type switch with a dedicated circuit.  
1. Securely mount the REPO station. Recommended locations include operator’s  
consoles or near exit doors. See Drawing 164201604-10 on page A-50 for  
enclosure dimensions and wiring knockouts.  
2. Verify the UPS system is turned off and all power sources are removed. See  
Chapter 10, “UPS Operating Instructions” for shutdown instructions.  
3. If not already open, unfasten the front door latch and swing the door open.  
4. If not already removed, remove the doors. Remove the retaining screws located  
inside each door at the top and bottom hinge pivot points, then lift the door off.  
Retain the hardware for later use.  
5. Remove the screws securing the control panel door and swing the door open.  
Retain the hardware for later use.  
®
5-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing a Remote Emergency Power-off Switch  
6. Remove the screws securing the internal panel covering the TB1 and TB2 terminal  
blocks at the top of the UPS cabinet (see Drawing 164201604-8 starting on  
page A-33).  
7. If installing interface wiring from the bottom of the cabinet, proceed to Step 8;  
otherwise, proceed to Step 10.  
8. Remove the screws securing the top internal safety shield panel and open the  
panel to gain access to the bottom wiring entry.  
9. Remove the screws securing the bottom internal safety shield panel and remove  
the panel to gain access to the bottom conduit landing plate.  
10. To locate the appropriate terminals and review the wiring and termination  
requirements, see Figure 5-1 and Drawing 164201604-8 starting on page A-33.  
11. Route and connect the wiring as shown in Table 5-1 and Table 5-2.  
12. If a normally-closed EPO switch is not used, ensure a jumper wire is connected  
between pins 1 and 2 on UPS TB1.  
Table 5-1. REPO Wire Terminations  
From REPO Station(s)  
To Customer Interface  
Terminal Board TB1 in UPS Cabinet  
Remarks  
TB1-4  
TB1-5  
TB-3  
TB-4  
Twisted Wires (2)  
14–22 AWG  
Table 5-2. REPO  
1 (NC)  
UPS TB1  
(LATCHING-TYPE  
SWITCH ONLY)  
2 (COMMON)  
3 (NO)  
4
REPO  
Switch  
(NO)  
Twisted  
Wires  
5
4 (COMMON)  
REPO switch rating is 24 Vdc. 1A minimum if supplied by customer.  
NOTE The REPO switch must be a latching-type switch with a dedicated circuit.  
®
5-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing a Remote Emergency Power-off Switch  
13. If you are installing multiple REPO stations, wire additional stations in parallel with  
the first REPO.  
14. If required, install wiring from the REPO station to trip circuitry of upstream  
protective devices. A normally-open (NO) contact is provided between terminals 6  
and 7 of REPO, as shown in Figure 5-1. REPO switch wiring must be in accordance  
with UL Class II requirements.  
15. When all wiring is complete, reinstall the safety shield panels removed in the  
previous steps.  
16. Close the control panel door and secure with the retained hardware.  
17. Reinstall the doors removed in Step 4 and secure with the retained hardware.  
18. Close the doors and secure the latch.  
®
5-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing a Remote Emergency Power-off Switch  
This page intentionally left blank.  
®
5-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 6 Installing Options and Accessories  
6.1 Installing a Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card  
As an option, a Powerware Hot Sync Computer Area Network Bridge Card shown in  
Figure 6-1, can be installed to provide connectivity for operational mode control and  
metering of a parallel system at any UPM in the system. In addition, this card can be used  
to connect optional system monitoring devices, such as a Remote Monitor Panel II, a Relay  
Interface Module II, or a Supervisory Contact Module II to the UPS.  
Plug-in Terminal  
Block J3  
Figure 6-1. Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card  
NOTE Only one Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card can be installed in the UPS.  
Multiple CAN cards are not supported and will cause system conflicts.  
1. Verify the UPS system is turned off and all power sources are removed. See  
Chapter 10, “UPS Operating Instructions,” for shutdown instructions.  
2. If not already open, unfasten the front door latch and swing the door open.  
3. Install the Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card into an open X-Slot on the front  
of the UPS. Remove the X-Slot cover panel to gain access to the X-Slot. See  
Drawing 164201604-8 starting on page A-33 for location of the X-Slot  
communication bay.  
®
6-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Options and Accessories  
4. Install wiring from the Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card in accordance with  
the instructions listed below:  
Ī Parallel system wiring (see paragraph 6.2)  
Ī RMP II wiring (see paragraph 6.3)  
Ī RIM II (see paragraph 6.4)  
Ī SCM II (see paragraph 6.5)  
6.2 Installing Parallel System Control Wiring  
NOTE When installing external wiring to the X-Slot CAN card, conduit must be  
installed to the UPS cabinet. When installing internal wiring to the X-Slot CAN card  
terminals, route the wiring through the internal opening in the X-Slot communication  
bay.  
NOTE When installing interface wiring for the parallel system pull chain, conduit  
must be installed between UPMs.  
To install parallel system control wiring, perform the following procedure:  
1. Verify the UPS system is turned off and all power sources are removed. See  
Chapter 10, “UPS Operating Instructions,” for shutdown instructions.  
2. Perform the procedure listed in paragraph 6.1.  
3. If not already removed, remove the doors. Remove the retaining screws located  
inside each door at the top and bottom hinge pivot points, then lift the door off.  
Retain the hardware for later use.  
4. Remove the screws securing the control panel door and swing the door open.  
Retain the hardware for later use.  
5. Remove the screws securing the top internal safety shield panel. Remove the panel  
to gain access to the TB1 and TB2 terminal blocks, X-Slot communication bays,  
and the top conduit landing plate (see Drawing 164201604-8 starting on  
page A-33). Retain the hardware for later use.  
6. If installing interface wiring from the bottom of the cabinet, proceed to Step 7;  
otherwise, proceed to Step 8.  
7. Remove the screws securing the bottom internal safety shield panel and remove  
the panel to gain access to the bottom conduit landing plate.  
8. Remove the X-Slot conduit landing plate from the UPS cabinet to drill or punch  
conduit holes (see Drawing 164201604-6 on page A-27).  
9. Reinstall the conduit landing plate and install the conduit.  
10. Install CAN wiring between UPMs. See Drawing 164201604-8 starting on page A-33  
for Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card location, terminal location, and wiring  
information.  
®
6-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Options and Accessories  
11. Install parallel system backup control (pull chain) wiring between UPMs. See  
Drawing 164201604-8 starting on page A-33 for terminal locations and wiring  
information.  
12. Install parallel system backup control (pull chain) wiring between the bypass relay  
and building alarm 2. See Drawing 164201604-8 starting on page A-33 for terminal  
locations and wiring information.  
NOTE Setup of the Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card for parallel operation must  
be performed by an authorized Eaton Customer Service Engineer. Contact service to  
schedule a date.  
13. When all wiring is complete, reinstall the safety shield panels removed in previous  
steps. Secure with the retained hardware.  
14. Close the control panel door and secure with the retained hardware.  
15. Reinstall the doors removed previously and secure with the retained hardware.  
16. Close the doors and secure the latch.  
6.3 Installing a Remote Monitor Panel II  
To install RMP II wiring, perform the following procedure:  
1. Verify the UPS system is turned off and all power sources are removed. See  
Chapter 10, “UPS Operating Instructions,” for shutdown instructions.  
2. Perform the procedure listed in paragraph 6.1.  
NOTE If mounting to a hollow wall, secure the enclosure to a wood or metal stud within  
the wall. Do not use hollow wall anchors.  
3. Securely mount the RMP II at the desired location. See drawing 164201604-11 on  
page A-51 for mounting hole locations.  
NOTE When installing signal wiring for CAN card J3 terminals, conduit must be  
installed between the device and the UPS cabinet.  
NOTE Remove the UPS cabinet top or bottom conduit landing plate to drill or punch  
conduit holes (see Drawing 164201604-6 on page A-27).  
4. Remove the X-Slot conduit landing plate from the UPS cabinet to drill or punch  
conduit holes (see Drawing 164201604-6 on page A-27).  
5. Reinstall the conduit landing plate.  
6. Install conduit between the UPS and RMP II. See Appendix A for UPS cabinet and  
RMP II wiring access information.  
®
6-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Options and Accessories  
7. Install wiring between the UPS and RMP II. See Drawing 164201604-8 starting on  
page A-33 for Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card and RMP II location, terminal  
location, and wiring information.  
NOTE 120 Vac for the RMP II should be supplied from the critical bus by facility  
planners or the customer.  
8. Install 120 Vac power wiring from the critical bus to the RMP II. See Drawing  
164201604-8 starting on page A-33 for terminal location and wiring information.  
NOTE Setup of the Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card must be performed by an  
authorized Eaton Customer Service Engineer. Contact service to schedule a date.  
9. To check the operation of the RMP II, ensure that the UPS is supplying the load via  
inverter or bypass. If the indicators on the RMP II show the appropriate status,  
then it is operating correctly.  
If the communication link between the UPS and the RMP II is not present, the  
RMP II performs a self-test (all indicators flash and the horn beeps at one-second  
intervals). If the self-test occurs, check all harness connectors and the fuse for  
proper seating. If all connections are secure but the RMP II continues to self-test,  
replace the fuse with the spare included in the hardware kit. If a fuse replacement  
does not correct the problem, contact your Eaton service representative for  
verification that the RMP II is working correctly.  
10. To test the indicator lamps, press and hold the horn silence pushbutton for  
3 seconds. All lamps should illuminate, and the horn sounds continuously until you  
release the pushbutton.  
6.4 Installing a Relay Interface Module II  
To install RIM II wiring, perform the following procedure:  
1. Verify the UPS system is turned off and all power sources are removed. See  
Chapter 10, “UPS Operating Instructions,” for shutdown instructions.  
2. Perform the procedure listed in paragraph 6.1.  
NOTE If mounting to a hollow wall, secure the enclosure to a wood or metal stud within  
the wall. Do not use hollow wall anchors.  
3. Securely mount the RIM II at the desired location. See drawing 164201604-12 for  
mounting hole locations.  
®
6-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Options and Accessories  
NOTE When installing signal wiring for CAN card J3 terminals, conduit must be  
installed between the device and the UPS cabinet.  
NOTE Remove the UPS cabinet top or bottom conduit landing plate to drill or punch  
conduit holes (see Drawing 164201604-6 on page A-27).  
4. Remove the X-Slot conduit landing plate from the UPS cabinet to drill or punch  
conduit holes (see Drawing 164201604-6 on page A-27).  
5. Reinstall the conduit landing plate.  
6. Install conduit between the UPS and RIM II. See Appendix A for UPS cabinet and  
RIM II wiring access information.  
7. Install wiring between the UPS and RIM II. See Drawing 164201604-8 starting on  
page A-33 for Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card and RIM II location, terminal  
location, and wiring information.  
NOTE 120 Vac for the RIM II should be supplied from the critical bus by facility  
planners or the customer.  
8. Install 120 Vac power wiring from the critical bus to the RIM II. See Drawing  
164201604-8 starting on page A-33 for terminal location and wiring information.  
NOTE Setup of the Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card must be performed by an  
authorized Eaton Customer Service Engineer. Contact service to schedule a date.  
9. Contact your Eaton service representative for verification and testing of the RIM II  
and its connections prior to making connections with J1 through J4 (see Table 6-1  
and Drawing 164201604-12 on page A-52).  
You can order interface cables separately for connecting to the 15-Pin D-Sub  
Connectors.  
Table 6-1. J1 through J4 Interface Connectors  
Status  
J1 through J4  
Description  
Pins 1 and 12 Contacts are closed when the UPS is offline.  
UPS AVAILABLE  
UPS OFFLINE  
Pins 3 and 13 Contacts are closed when the UPS is operating in  
Normal mode.  
Pins 5 and 14 Contacts are closed when approximately two minutes of  
battery time is remaining before the critical load is lost.  
BATTERY WEAK  
UTILITY FAILURE  
Pins 6 and 15 Contacts are closed when Utility Failure is detected.  
®
6-5  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Options and Accessories  
6.5 Installing a Supervisory Contact Module II  
To install SCM II wiring, perform the following procedure:  
1. Verify the UPS system is turned off and all power sources are removed. See  
Chapter 10, “UPS Operating Instructions,” for shutdown instructions.  
2. Perform the procedure listed in paragraph 6.1.  
NOTE If mounting to a hollow wall, secure the enclosure to a wood or metal stud within  
the wall. Do not use hollow wall anchors.  
3. Securely mount the SCM II at the desired location. See drawing 164201604-13 on  
page A-54 for mounting hole locations.  
NOTE When installing signal wiring for CAN card J3 terminals, conduit must be  
installed between the device and the UPS cabinet.  
NOTE Remove the UPS cabinet top or bottom conduit landing plate to drill or punch  
conduit holes (see Drawing 164201604-6 on page A-27).  
4. Remove the X-Slot conduit landing plate from the UPS cabinet to drill or punch  
conduit holes (see Drawing 164201604-6 on page A-27).  
5. Reinstall the conduit landing plate.  
6. Install conduit between the UPS and SCM II. See Appendix A for UPS cabinet and  
SCM II wiring access information.  
7. Install wiring between the UPS and SCM II. See Drawing 164201604-8 starting on  
page A-33 for Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card and SCM II location, terminal  
location, and wiring information.  
NOTE 120 Vac for the SCM II should be supplied from the critical bus by facility  
planners or the customer.  
8. Install 120 Vac power wiring from the critical bus to the SCM II. See Drawing  
164201604-8 starting on page A-33 for terminal location and wiring information.  
NOTE Setup of the Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card must be performed by an  
authorized Eaton Customer Service Engineer. Contact service to schedule a date.  
®
6-6  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Options and Accessories  
9. Install wiring between the SCM II terminal block TB2 and the monitoring  
equipment. See Figure 6-2 for terminal assignments and Drawing 164201604-8 on  
page A-33 for terminal block location.  
System Normal  
No Redundancy  
On Generator  
Bypass Not  
Available  
TB2  
On Battery  
UPS Alarm  
On Bypass  
Shutdown  
Imminent  
Figure 6-2. Supervisory Contact Module II TB2  
NOTE Supervisory contacts are rated at 2.0A at 28 Vdc or 120 Vac and 0.15A at 115 Vdc.  
NOTE Supervisory contacts require an external power supply. Internal 24 Vdc is not  
capable of supplying contact current.  
®
6-7  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing Options and Accessories  
This page intentionally left blank.  
®
6-8  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section II Operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This page intentionally left blank.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 7 Understanding UPS Operation  
7.1 Looking Inside the UPS System  
The Powerware 9390 UPS is a continuous-duty, solid-state, transformerless (at 208 and  
480 Vac), three-phase, true online system that provides conditioned and uninterruptible  
AC power to the UPS system’s output. The UPS supports process control, data processing,  
telecommunications/PBX, research, and non-patient medical equipment. The Powerware  
9390 UPS maintains power to the critical loads during commercial electrical power  
brownout, blackout, overvoltage, undervoltage, and out-of-tolerance frequency conditions.  
The basic system consists of a rectifier, battery converter, inverter, monitoring/operation  
control panel, integrated communication server, and digital signal processor (DSP) logic.  
In this manual, the power required by your equipment is called the critical load. The UPS  
supplies the critical load with conditioned power that is synchronized with your utility  
power. Figure 7-1 shows the main elements of the UPS system.  
Battery  
Battery  
Breaker  
Battery  
Converter  
Input  
Contactor  
K1  
Output  
Contactor  
K3  
AC Input to  
Rectifier/  
Charger  
Rectifier  
Inverter  
Power Module  
Digital  
Metering  
AC Output  
to Critical  
Load  
Static  
AC Input to  
Bypass  
Switch  
Backfeed  
Protection  
Contactor  
K5  
UPS Cabinet  
Figure 7-1. Main Elements of the UPS System  
®
7-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
If utility power is interrupted or falls outside the parameters specified in Chapter 15,  
“Product Specifications,” the UPS uses a backup battery supply to maintain power to the  
critical load for a specified period of time or until the utility power returns. For extended  
power outages, the UPS allows you to either transfer to an alternative power system (such  
as a generator) or shut down your critical load in an orderly manner.  
The emergency bypass consists of a continuous-duty static switch and backfeed protection  
contactor K5. The backfeed protection contactor is located in series with the static switch.  
For manual transfers to bypass, the static switch is also used. The static switch is armed and  
ready during both types of transfers.  
The operation of the UPS system is described in greater detail in the following paragraphs.  
The UPS module may be configured for standalone, single module, Reverse Transfer (RT)  
operation or multiple module, parallel redundant and/or parallel capacity operation (see  
paragraphs 7.2 and 7.3).  
7.2 Single Module Reverse Transfer (RT)  
A single module operates independently to support an applied load from the inverter,  
providing conditioned and uninterruptible AC power to the critical load from the output of  
the module. During an outage, the inverter continues to operate, supporting power to the  
load from the battery supply. If the unit requires service, applied loads are transferred to  
the internal bypass, continuous-duty static switch either automatically or manually. With  
the exception of a battery cabinet, no other cabinets or equipment are required for the  
single module to successfully support its applied loads.  
7.2.1 Single Module RT Modes  
The Powerware 9390 UPS supports a critical load in three different modes of operation.  
The UPS can automatically use all three modes, as required. The standard operation  
modes are:  
Ī In Normal mode, the critical load is supplied by the inverter, which derives its power  
from rectified utility AC power. In this mode, the battery charger also provides charging  
current for the battery, if needed.  
Ī In Battery mode, the battery provides DC power, which maintains inverter operation.  
The battery supports the critical load.  
Ī In Bypass mode, the critical load is directly supported by utility power.  
®
7-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
The UPS continually monitors itself and the incoming utility power, and automatically  
switches between these modes as required, without operator intervention. The  
sophisticated detection and switching logic inside the UPS ensures that operating mode  
changes are automatic and transparent to the critical load, while internal monitoring  
systems indicate the current mode of operation. The UPS switches operating modes in  
response to these system events:  
Ī A command is an intervention that is externally initiated by an operator or by some site  
action. A command causes the UPS to switch operating modes; it usually does not  
require any further action.  
Ī A notice is a minor system event that may or may not require attention.  
Ī An alarm is a system event that requires immediate operator intervention.  
System events, alarm horns, and indicator lights are described in Chapter 12, “Responding  
to System Events.”  
The following paragraphs describe the differences in the three UPS operating modes, using  
block diagrams to show the power flow during each mode of operation.  
®
7-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
7.2.2 Normal Mode – RT  
Figure 7-2 shows the path of electrical power through the UPS system when the UPS is  
operating in Normal mode.  
Static  
K5  
Switch  
Rectifier  
Inverter  
K1  
K3  
Battery  
Converter  
Main Power Flow  
Trickle Current  
Energized  
Breakers Contactors  
Closed  
Battery  
Breaker  
Open  
De-Energized  
Battery  
Figure 7-2. Path of Current Through the UPS in Normal Mode – RT  
During normal UPS operation, power for the system is derived from a utility input source  
through the rectifier input contactor K1. The front panel displays “Normal,” indicating the  
incoming power is within voltage and frequency acceptance windows. Three-phase AC  
input power is converted to DC using IGBT devices to produce a regulated DC voltage to  
the inverter. The battery is charged directly from the regulated rectifier output through a  
buck or boost DC converter, depending on whether the system is 208V or 480V and the  
size of the battery string attached to the unit.  
The battery converter derives its input from the regulated DC output of the rectifier and  
provides either a boosted or bucked regulated DC voltage charge current to the battery.  
The UPS monitors the battery charge condition and reports the status on the control panel.  
The battery is always connected to the UPS and ready to support the inverter should the  
utility input become unavailable.  
®
7-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
The neutral from the system input is connected to the neutral regulator in the DC  
capacitors. The output neutral of the system is connected with the required neutral  
supplied at the utility bypass input and should never be bonded to ground at the module’s  
output.  
The inverter produces a three-phase AC output to a customer’s load without the use of a  
transformer. The inverter derives regulated DC from the rectifier and uses IGBT devices  
and pulse-width modulation (PWM) to produce a regulated and filtered AC output. The AC  
output of the inverter is delivered to the system output through the output contactor K3.  
If the utility AC power is interrupted or is out of specification, the UPS automatically  
switches to Battery mode to support the critical load without interruption. When utility  
power returns, the UPS returns to Normal mode.  
If the UPS becomes overloaded or unavailable, the UPS switches to Bypass mode. The UPS  
automatically returns to Normal mode when the overload condition is cleared and system  
operation is restored within specified limits.  
If the UPS suffers an internal failure, it switches automatically to Bypass mode and remains  
in that mode until the failure is corrected and the UPS is back in service.  
®
7-5  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
7.2.3 Bypass Mode – RT  
The UPS automatically switches to Bypass mode if it detects an overload, load fault, or  
internal failure. The bypass source supplies the commercial AC power to the load directly.  
Figure 7-3 shows the path of electrical power through the UPS system when operating in  
Bypass mode.  
C A U T I O N  
The critical load is not protected while the UPS is in Bypass mode.  
Static  
K5  
Switch  
Rectifier  
Inverter  
K1  
K3  
Battery  
Converter  
Main Power Flow  
Trickle Current  
Energized  
Breakers Contactors  
Closed  
Battery  
Breaker  
Open  
De-Energized  
Battery  
Figure 7-3. Path of Current Through the UPS in Bypass Mode – RT  
In Bypass mode, the output of the system is provided with three-phase AC power directly  
from the system input. While in this mode, the output of the system is not protected from  
voltage or frequency fluctuations or power outages from the source. Some power line  
filtering and spike protection is provided to the load but no active power conditioning or  
battery support is available to the output of the system in the Bypass mode of operation.  
The internal bypass is comprised of a solid-state, silicon-controlled rectifier (SCR) static  
switch (SSW) and a backfeed protection contactor K5. The static switch is rated as a  
continuous-duty device that is used anytime the inverter is unable to support the applied  
load. The static switch is wired in series with the backfeed protection contactor, and  
together they are wired in parallel with the rectifier and inverter. The static switch, being  
an electronically-controlled device, can be turned on immediately to pick up the load from  
the inverter while the inverter output contactor K3 opens to isolates the inverter. The  
backfeed protection contactor is normally always closed, ready to support the static switch  
unless the bypass input source becomes unavailable.  
®
7-6  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
During an outage, the UPS prohibits transfers to bypass and provides upstream protection.  
The backfeed protection contactor is opened, preventing system output voltage from  
bleeding across the static switch snubber components to the bypass input source.  
To ensure the load remains energized, the UPS automatically transfers the output to the  
internal bypass when one of these abnormal conditions occur: the output of the system  
exceeds acceptable voltage and frequency tolerances, the system is overloaded, or the  
inverter fails. The transfer is initiated by turning on the static switch and opening the  
output contactor K3, also called a Make-Before-Break transfer. The transfer occurs in less  
than 4 mS (quarter cycle) to ensure that the output load is not interrupted. The static  
switch remains on until either the inverter is able to support the system output or the unit  
is placed into a maintenance position where repairs can be made.  
If the UPS initiates its own transfer to bypass for any reason other than operator  
intervention, the UPS attempts to restart the inverter (if not running already) and attempts  
a transfer back online to support the output of the system. Three attempts are made  
within ten minutes to return the inverter online automatically before the UPS locks out any  
further attempts. After three attempts, the UPS remains in bypass and an alarm condition  
is enunciated. The UPS can also be transferred to bypass using the front panel controls.  
Bypass mode is a normal operating mode, not an alarm condition. However, if the UPS is  
unable to return to Normal mode following an automatic transfer to Bypass mode, an  
alarm condition is recorded.  
®
7-7  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
7.2.4 Battery Mode – RT  
The UPS automatically transfers to Battery mode if a utility power outage occurs, or if the  
utility power does not conform to specified parameters. In Battery mode, the battery  
provides emergency DC power that the inverter converts to AC power.  
Figure 7-4 shows the path of electrical power through the UPS system when operating in  
Battery mode.  
Static  
K5  
Switch  
Rectifier  
Inverter  
K1  
K3  
Battery  
Converter  
Main Power Flow  
Trickle Current  
Energized  
Breakers Contactors  
Closed  
CB2  
Open  
De-Energized  
Battery  
Figure 7-4. Path of Current Through the UPS in Battery Mode – RT  
During a utility power failure, the rectifier no longer has an AC utility source from which to  
supply the DC output current required to support the inverter. The input contactor K1  
opens and the battery instantaneously supplies energy to the battery converter. The  
converter either bucks or boosts the voltage so that the inverter can support the  
customer’s load without interruption. If bypass is common with the rectifier input, the  
backfeed protection contactor K5 also opens. The opening of contactors K1 and K5  
prevent system voltages from bleeding backwards through the static switch and rectifier  
snubber components and re-entering the input source.  
While in Battery mode, the UPS sounds an audible horn, illuminates a visual indicator lamp  
on the front panel (System Normal, On Battery), and creates an entry into the alarm event  
history. As the battery discharges, the converter and inverter constantly make minute  
adjustments to maintain a steady output. The UPS remains in this operating mode until the  
input power to the rectifier is again within the specified voltage or frequency acceptance  
windows.  
®
7-8  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
If the input power fails to return or is not within the acceptance windows required for  
normal operation, the battery continues discharging until a DC voltage level is reached  
where the inverter output can no longer support the connected loads. When this event  
occurs, the UPS issues another set of audible and visual alarms indicating SHUTDOWN  
IMMINENT. Unless the rectifier has a valid AC input soon, the output can be supported for  
only two minutes before the output of the system shuts down. If the bypass source is  
available, the UPS transfers to bypass instead of shutting down.  
If at any time during the battery discharge the input power becomes available again,  
contactors K1 and K5 close and the rectifier begins to supply DC current to the converter  
and inverter. At this point, the unit returns to Normal mode. Depending on the total load  
and the duration of the battery discharge, battery current limit alarms may be seen for a  
short time due to the current required to recharge the battery.  
The system’s total operating time on battery depends on many factors. Some factors that  
affect battery support times are battery type and capacity, number of parallel strings,  
environmental temperatures, age of the battery, and fluctuations in load demand during  
the discharge. The greater the load, the less support time the battery has. Decreasing the  
load generally increases the battery support time.  
7.3 Multiple Module Parallel System  
Parallel operation extends the normal operation of Powerware 9390 UPS units by offering  
increased capacity and/or redundant capability. The parallel system continues to maintain  
power to the critical loads during commercial electrical power brownout, blackout,  
overvoltage, undervoltage, and out-of-tolerance frequency conditions. See Drawing  
164201604-4, sheets 4 of 6, 5 of 6, and 6 of 6 in Appendix A, for a detailed relationship of  
the parallel system.  
The output of the system is normally supplied by several uninterruptible power modules.  
Multiple UPMs are connected with their outputs in parallel (tied together) to provide a  
load level greater than the rating of one UPM and/or for redundancy. The paralleled UPMs  
supply the output load with protected power as long as the load does not exceed the  
combined rating of the paralleled UPMs.  
The power system is redundant as long as one of the UPMs can be disconnected from the  
output bus and the remaining UPMs can continue to supply power to the load without  
exceeding their ratings.  
When the load is being supplied by the UPMs, the system output bus is continuously  
monitored for an overvoltage or undervoltage condition. If an out of limits condition is  
detected, the paralleled UPMs transfer the load to bypass using the UPM static switches.  
Communication is required between the UPMs for system metering and mode control.  
System level communication and control are accomplished using a Computer Area  
Network. A single building alarm in each UPM, connected to the other UPMs in parallel,  
and tied to the bypass contactor auxiliary contacts in each UPM are used for a secondary  
communication path. This arrangement ensures bypass control even if the CAN bus is lost.  
®
7-9  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
Up to four units can be paralleled for redundancy or capacity without any additional  
cabinets.  
The system is paralleled for redundancy (1+1) in a system where two UPMs are paralleled  
together and the load is less than the supporting capability of one of the UPMs. The system  
is paralleled for capacity (2+0) if both UPMs in a system are required to support the load.  
A parallel capacity system can also be redundant (2+1), as long as there is always one or  
more UPMs online than required to support the load.  
7.3.1 Multiple Module Parallel System Modes  
Similar to the single module system, the Powerware 9390 UPS parallel system supports a  
critical load in three different modes of operation. The standard operation modes are:  
Ī In Normal mode, the paralleled UPMs supply the critical load with clean, filtered power.  
Each UPM battery charger also provides charging current for the battery if needed.  
Ī In Battery mode, the battery provides DC power, which maintains UPM operation. The  
UPM batteries support the critical load.  
Ī In Bypass mode, the critical load is directly supported by utility power through the  
continuous-duty static bypass switch in each UPM.  
The UPMs continually monitor themselves and the incoming utility power, and  
automatically switch between these modes as required, without operator intervention,  
except when manually switching to Bypass mode. The sophisticated detection and  
switching logic inside the UPMs ensures that operating mode changes are automatic and  
transparent to the critical load, while internal monitoring systems indicate the current  
mode of operation. The UPMs switch operating modes in response to these system events:  
Ī A command is an intervention that is externally initiated by an operator or by some site  
action. A command causes the UPMs to switch operating modes; it usually does not  
require any further action.  
Ī A notice is a minor system event that may or may not require attention.  
Ī An alarm is a system event that requires immediate intervention.  
System events, alarm horns, and indicator lights are described in Chapter 12, “Responding  
to System Events.”  
To assist in developing an understanding of the parallel system modes of operation, review  
and understand thoroughly the single module modes of operation.  
The following paragraphs describe the differences in the three parallel system operating  
modes, using block diagrams to show the power flow during each mode of operation.  
®
7-10  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
7.3.2 Normal Mode – Parallel  
In Normal mode, utility AC power is supplied to the UPMs. Each UPM then conditions the  
incoming AC power and provides clean, regulated AC power to either a module tie cabinet  
or distribution panel for parallel systems up to four modules. The applied load is equally  
shared among the available UPMs in the system.  
Figure 7-5 shows the path of electrical power through the parallel system when operating  
in Normal mode.  
Bypass Input  
UPM Input  
Module Tie Cabinet  
UPM 1 Output  
UPM 1  
UPM 2  
UPM 3  
UPM 4  
Battery  
Battery  
Battery  
UPM 2 Output  
UPM 3 Output  
UPM 4 Output  
Battery  
Breakers  
Closed  
Open  
Output to  
Critical  
Load  
Main Power Flow  
Figure 7-5. Path of Current through the UPMs in Normal Mode – Parallel  
If the utility AC power is interrupted or is out of specification, the UPMs automatically  
switch to Battery mode to support the critical load without interruption. When utility  
power returns, the UPMs return to Normal mode.  
If the UPMs become overloaded or unavailable, the parallel system switches to Bypass  
mode. The parallel system automatically returns to Normal mode when the overload  
condition is cleared and system operation is restored within specified limits.  
®
7-11  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
7.3.3 Bypass Mode – Parallel  
In Bypass mode, the output of the system is provided with three-phase AC power directly  
from the bypass input. While in this mode, the output of the system is not protected from  
fluctuations, spikes, or power outages from the source. No power filtering, conditioning, or  
battery support is available to the output of the system in the Bypass mode of operation.  
The parallel system automatically switches to Bypass mode if it detects a UPM overload,  
UPMs unavailable, load fault, or internal failure.  
Figure 7-6 shows the path of electrical power through the parallel system when operating  
in Bypass mode.  
Bypass Input  
UPM Input  
Module Tie Cabinet  
UPM 1 Output  
UPM 1  
UPM 2  
UPM 3  
UPM 4  
Battery  
Battery  
Battery  
UPM 2 Output  
UPM 3 Output  
UPM 4 Output  
Battery  
Breakers  
Closed  
Output to  
Critical  
Load  
Main Power Flow  
Open  
Figure 7-6. Path of Current through the UPMs in Bypass Mode – Parallel  
In a parallel redundant or capacity type system, each module operates similar to a single  
module, but in parallel with each other. The bypass source for the load is derived from the  
bypass input of one, two, three, or four modules, depending on the system configuration  
through the internal continuous-duty static switches. If a module is taken offline, the other  
modules remain online to support the load. If more modules than can support the load  
must be taken offline, the load must be transferred to maintenance bypass or shut down.  
®
7-12  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
The parallel system can be transferred from Normal mode to Bypass mode manually.  
However, the parallel system automatically switches to Bypass mode whenever the UPMs  
can no longer supply the critical load. If the parallel system transfers to Bypass mode from  
Normal mode due to an output voltage deviation, the parallel system automatically  
attempts to return to Normal mode (up to three times within a 10-minute period). After  
three transfer attempts or an overload, the system locks the critical load to the bypass  
source and requires operator intervention to transfer.  
Bypass mode is a normal operating mode, not an alarm condition. However, if the parallel  
system is unable to return to Normal mode following an automatic transfer to Bypass  
mode, an alarm condition is recorded.  
Bypass may also be used when the modules in the system must be shut down to perform  
routine maintenance or repairs.  
In the Parallel Redundant (N + 1) arrangement, the continuous-duty static switch in each  
module operates to support the applied loads on bypass. If both units are in NORMAL and  
one unit trips offline, the remaining unit does not go to bypass as long as it has the  
capacity to support the load.  
In the Parallel Capacity (N + 0) arrangement, if one unit trips offline and goes to bypass,  
the remaining units also go to bypass.  
®
7-13  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
7.3.4 Battery Mode – Parallel  
The UPMs transfer to Battery mode automatically if a utility power outage occurs, or if the  
utility power does not conform to specified parameters. In Battery mode, the battery  
provides emergency DC power that the inverter converts to AC power.  
Figure 7-7 shows the path of electrical power through the parallel system when operating  
in Battery mode.  
Bypass Input  
UPM Input  
Module Tie Cabinet  
UPM 1 Output  
UPM 1  
UPM 2  
UPM 3  
UPM 4  
Battery  
Battery  
Battery  
UPM 2 Output  
UPM 3 Output  
UPM 4 Output  
Battery  
Breakers  
Closed  
Output to  
Critical  
Load  
Main Power Flow  
Open  
Figure 7-7. Path of Current through the UPMs in Battery Mode – Parallel  
While in Battery mode, the UPMs sound an audible horn, illuminate a visual indicator lamp  
on the front panel (System Normal, On Battery), and create an entry into the alarm event  
history. As the battery discharges, the boost converter and inverter constantly make minute  
adjustments maintaining a steady output. The UPMs remain in this operating mode until  
the input power to the rectifier is again within the specified voltage or frequency  
acceptance windows.  
®
7-14  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
If the input power fails to return or is not within the acceptance windows required for  
normal operation, the battery continues discharging until a DC voltage level is reached  
where the inverter output can no longer support the shared loads. When this event occurs  
on each UPM, UPMs that are about to be shut down issue another set of audible and visual  
alarms that indicate a two-minute SHUTDOWN IMMINENT warning. Unless the system has  
a valid AC input soon, redundant UPMs begin shutting down until there are no longer  
enough UPMs online to support the connected load. When this event occurs, the system  
shuts down. If the bypass source is available, the system transfers to bypass instead of  
shutting down.  
If at any time during the battery discharge the input power becomes available again, the  
rectifier begins to supply DC current to the inverter. At this point, the unit returns to  
Normal mode. If at any time during the battery discharge the AC input power becomes  
available again, each rectifier turns on, assumes the inverter load from the batteries, and  
begins recharging the batteries. Depending on the total load and the duration of the  
battery discharge, battery and rectifier input current limit alarms may be seen for a short  
time due to the current required to recharge the batteries.  
7.4 Functional Description  
The UPS is a true online double-conversion unit with a transformerless power train. A  
high-frequency active rectifier powers a high-frequency three-phase inverter. The bypass  
circuit uses a solid-state continuous-duty static switch. The UPS operates from battery  
strings from 192 cells (384V) to 240 cells (480V).  
7.4.1 Input Rectifier  
The rectifier is a three-phase, high-frequency PWM, IGBT-based power conversion stage  
that provides input power factor correction and low input current harmonic distortion. The  
rectifier maintains a DC level that is optimized for maximum inverter efficiency. A  
precharge system charges the energy storage elements in the power train prior to  
energizing the rectifier.  
7.4.2 Inverter  
The inverter is a three-phase, high-frequency PWM, IGBT-based power conversion stage  
that continuously supplies the critical load with high-quality AC power. The IGBTs are  
modulated to maintain the highest efficiency.  
7.4.3 Battery Charger and Advanced Battery Management  
The charger is a high-frequency, IGBT-based power conversion stage. The UPS uses  
Advanced Battery Management (ABM) technology, which essentially isolates the battery  
from the electrical environment, except for periodic charging or reserve mode operation,  
extending its life.  
ABM extends battery life by keeping the batteries charged and performing periodic battery  
testing.  
®
7-15  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding UPS Operation  
An ABM charging cycle starts with the charger driving the battery voltage, at maximum  
current limit, to a battery charge level of 2.34 volts/cell. The time it takes for the voltage to  
reach to the battery charge level is saved as the battery charge time. If the battery charge  
time exceeds 100 hours, an alarm sounds.  
As soon as a battery charge level of 2.34 volts/cell is reached, the battery is charged at a  
float level of 2.31 volts/cell for 48 hours (battery float time) plus 150% of battery charge  
time. Twenty-four hours into the float period, a series of battery tests are performed to  
check the battery health. The float level charge continues after a successful test.  
At initial startup, the battery run time on the front panel display indicates two minutes.  
After the 24-hour float charging period and battery testing, the actual battery run time is  
determined and the actual battery run time is displayed.  
After the float period is completed, the charger is disconnected and the batteries are  
allowed to rest for 672 hours (28 days) maximum rest time. If the battery voltage falls  
below the opportunity charge level of 2.1 volts/cell during the first 240 hours of the rest  
period, an alarm sounds.  
An ABM charge cycle is initiated whenever one of these four conditions occurs since the  
last charge cycle:  
Ī The batteries have rested over the maximum rest time of 672 hours.  
Ī Accumulated discharge time is over a maximum battery discharge time of 20 seconds.  
Ī Battery voltage is under the opportunity charge level of 2.1 volts/cell and the unit has  
been in rest mode for longer than 240 hours.  
Ī An XCP command Initiate Battery Test is received.  
7.4.4 Bypass  
The bypass has a continuous-duty fully-rated SCR switch in the bypass circuit and a  
contactor in the inverter leg. In Normal mode, the contactor connects the inverter to the  
output. A backfeed contactor is also provided.  
7.4.5 Batteries  
The UPS operates from battery strings from 192 cells (384V nominal) to 240 cells  
(480V nominal).  
®
7-16  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 8 Features, Options, and Accessories  
8.1 UPS Standard Features  
The UPS has many standard features that provide cost-effective and consistently reliable  
power protection.  
8.1.1 Control Panel  
The control panel, located on the UPS front door, contains an LCD and pushbutton  
switches to control the operation of the UPS, and to display the status of the UPS system.  
See Chapter 9, “Using the Control Panel,” for additional information.  
8.1.2 Customer Interface  
8.1.2.1 Building Alarm Monitoring  
The facility’s alarm system contacts can be connected to two inputs in the UPS. The UPS  
uses these inputs to monitor the building alarms in addition to the UPS status. See  
Chapter 11, “Using Features and Options,” for additional information.  
8.1.2.2 Alarm Contact  
One alarm contact is provided for connection to equipment at the facility, such as a light,  
an audible alarm, or a computer terminal. The equipment connected to this contact alerts  
you to a UPS alarm. See Chapter 11, “Using Features and Options,” for additional  
information.  
8.1.3 X-Slot Communication Bay  
A two-slot communication bay is standard equipment, with an additional two-slot bay  
available as an option with the installation of a mini-CSB. Two to four optional X-Slot cards  
can be installed in the UPS module at any time. See Chapter 13, “Communication,” for  
additional information.  
8.1.4 ConnectUPS-X Web/SNMP Card X-Slot Card  
t
A ConnectUPS -X Web/SNMP Card is provided as standard equipment and provides remote  
monitoring through a Web browser interface, e-mail, and a network management system  
(NMS) using SNMP. See Chapter 13, “Communication,” for additional information.  
®
8-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Features, Options, and Accessories  
8.1.5 Advanced Battery Management  
A three-stage charging system increases battery service life by optimizing recharge time,  
and protects batteries from damage due to high current charging and inverter ripple  
currents. Charging at high currents can overheat and damage batteries.  
8.1.6 LanSafe Power Management Software  
LanSafe Power Management Software is bundled as part of the Powerware Software Suite  
CD shipped with the UPS. See Chapter 13, “Communication,” for additional information.  
8.1.7 Installation Features  
Cabinets can be permanently bolted to the floor or left standing on leveling feet.  
Power and control wiring can be routed through the top or bottom of the cabinet with  
connections made to easily accessible terminals. External sensing and monitoring control  
wire must be installed in accordance with Class 1 wiring methods. Line-up-and-match  
battery cabinets are wired through the side panels of the units.  
Optional X-Slot connectivity cards are quickly installed at the front of the unit and are  
hot-pluggable.  
8.2 Options and Accessories  
Contact an Eaton sales representative for information about the following options.  
8.2.1 Integrated Battery Cabinets  
Battery backup protection can be enhanced by equipping the UPS system with up to four  
Powerware 9390 battery cabinets containing sealed lead-acid, maintenance-free batteries.  
The battery cabinets are available in small and large sizes, with 192-cell (208V units only),  
216-cell, and 240-cell configurations. The cabinets are designed for line-up-and-match  
installation, but may be installed separate from the UPS cabinet.  
8.2.2 Integrated Distribution Cabinet  
The IDC provides adaptation and expansion with distribution panelboards, distribution  
circuit breakers, a maintenance bypass switch, and voltage transformation. The IDC is  
housed in a single, free-standing cabinet designed for line-up-and-match installation, but  
may be installed separate from the UPS cabinet.  
®
8-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Features, Options, and Accessories  
8.2.3 Integrated Accessory Cabinet (IAC-B, IAC-T, and IAC-D)  
The following IACs are designed for use with the Powerware 9390 three-phase  
Uninterruptible Power Systems:  
Ī The IAC-B provides maintenance bypass functions.  
Ī The IAC-T provides parallel tie cabinet or parallel tie cabinet with maintenance bypass  
functions.  
Ī The IAC-D provides power distribution options for servers, racks, and other equipment  
via distribution panelboards, or distributes power to larger loads via distribution circuit  
breakers.  
The IACs are housed in a single, free-standing cabinets designed for line-up-and-match  
installation, but may be installed separate from the UPS cabinet.  
8.2.4 Powerware Hot Sync Parallel System  
A parallel UPS system with two to four uninterruptible power modules can be installed to  
provide a parallel capacity and/or redundant system. This load sharing system provides  
more capacity than a single UPS, and can provide backup, depending on the load and  
configuration. In addition, when one UPM is taken out of service for maintenance or is not  
operating properly, a redundant UPM continues to supply uninterrupted power to the  
critical load. A Powerware Hot Sync Computer Area Network Bridge X-Slot card provides  
connectivity for system metering and operational mode control. The parallel system  
consists of two to four UPMs each with a parallel CAN card, and a module tie cabinet or  
load distribution panel to act as a tie point. Each UPM requires a separate battery cabinet.  
8.2.5 Sync Control  
An optional Sync Control maintains the critical load outputs of two separate single module  
Powerware 9390 UPS systems in synchronization. This facilitates the uninterrupted transfer  
of the load from one load bus to another by means of transfer switches. The Sync Control  
is housed in a wall-mounted panel that can be located between the UPS units for easy  
wiring.  
8.2.6 Optional X-Slot Cards  
®
The optional X-Slot cards support several protocols, such as SNMP, HTTP, AS/400 , and  
®
Modbus . See Chapter 13, “Communication,” for additional information.  
8.2.7 Mini-CSB  
The installation of the mini-CSB provides two additional X-Slot bays, increased logging to  
512 events, five additional programmable languages, a real-time clock, four additional  
building alarms, and enhanced alarm contact programming.  
®
8-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Features, Options, and Accessories  
8.2.8 Remote Monitor Panel II  
An optional RMP II contains backlit status indicators and a local horn, allowing you to  
monitor the operational status and alarm condition of the UPS from virtually any location  
within your facility. This option is described further in Chapter 11, “Using Features and  
Options.”  
8.2.9 Relay Interface Module II  
An optional RIM II uses relay contact closures to indicate the operating status and alarm  
condition of the UPS. This option is described further in Chapter 11, “Using Features and  
Options.”  
8.2.10 Supervisory Contact Module II  
An optional SCM II establishes an interface between the UPS system equipment and the  
customer’s monitor. This option is described further in Chapter 11, “Using Features and  
Options.”  
8.3 Symbols, Controls, and Indicators  
The following are examples of symbols used on the UPS or accessories to alert you to  
important information:  
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK - Indicates that a risk of electric shock is present and  
the associated warning should be observed.  
CAUTION: REFER TO OPERATOR’S MANUAL - Refer to your operator’s manual  
for additional information, such as important operating and maintenance  
instructions.  
This symbol indicates that you should not discard the UPS or the UPS batteries  
in the trash. This product contains sealed, lead-acid batteries and must be  
disposed of properly. For more information, contact your local recycling/reuse  
or hazardous waste center.  
This symbol indicates that you should not discard waste electrical or electronic  
equipment (WEEE) in the trash. For proper disposal, contact your local  
recycling/reuse or hazardous waste center.  
®
8-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 9 Using the Control Panel  
This chapter describes the UPS control panel, including controls and indicators, and how to  
monitor UPS operation. The control panel (see Figure 9-1) is located on the front door of  
the UPS.  
3
PRESS ANY KEY TO CONTINUE  
1
2
Figure 9-1. UPS Control Panel  
The control panel consists of the following:  
Ī A liquid crystal display (LCD) (1)  
Ī A horizontal row of pushbutton switches (2)  
Ī A vertical column of status indicators (3)  
The following paragraphs describe using the UPS control panel to monitor the UPS. See  
Chapter 10, “UPS Operating Instructions,” for use of the operational controls.  
When the unit powers up, the screen displays the Eaton | Powerware logo as shown in  
Figure 9-1. To advance to the Main Menu and Mimic screen, press any control panel  
pushbutton once.  
®
9-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
9.1 Using the LCD and Pushbuttons  
The LCD on the control panel provides an operator interface with the UPS system.  
Figure 9-2 identifies the display areas discussed in the following sections.  
A
B
ALARM: INPUT AC UNDER VOLTAGE  
INPUT  
UPS  
BATT  
STSW  
SETUP  
OUTPUT  
BYPASS  
EVENTS  
C
D
METERS  
CONTROLS  
LOAD OFF  
Figure 9-2. Parts of the LCD  
A
The UPS status area automatically scrolls between the Powerware model number, current date  
and time, active alarms, active notices, and load percent and battery runtime for the UPS.  
Shown is a typical alarm message. For more information about alarms and notices, see  
Chapter 12, “Responding to System Events.”  
B
C
The information area contains data about UPS status and operations.  
The menu bar lists the titles of the available screens. To select a screen, press the pushbutton  
underneath the desired screen.  
D The navigation pushbuttons function depending on the screen displayed. Use the pushbuttons  
to select menu screens or scroll through available screens. The LCD options above the  
pushbuttons indicate each pushbutton’s function.  
You can use the LCD and the pushbuttons to:  
Ī Look at a log of UPS events (alarms, notices, and commands) (see paragraph 9.2.2)  
Ī Monitor UPS operation (see paragraph 9.2.3)  
Ī Set UPS parameters (see paragraphs 9.2.8 and 9.2.9)  
Ī Control UPS operation (see paragraph 9.3)  
After approximately 30 minutes, the display screen darkens. To restore the screen, press  
any pushbutton once.  
®
9-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
9.2 Using the Main Menu  
The UPS main menu bar allows you to display data in the information area to help you  
monitor and control UPS operation. The following menus and options are available:  
Menu  
Option  
Description  
EVENTS  
Displays the list of Active System Events and a historical log of  
system events.  
METERS  
Displays performance meters for the system or critical load.  
CONTROLS Displays the System Controls screen.  
SETUP  
Allows you to set the display contrast, set the date and time for the  
time stamp, configure the UPS serial communication ports, and view  
the firmware version numbers.  
LOAD OFF  
De-energizes the critical load and powers down the UPS.  
Returns to Main Menu and Mimic screen from the Events, Meters,  
Controls, or Setup screens. Returns to the main System Setup Level  
screen from a setup submenu.  
9.2.1 Mimic Screen  
Figure 9-3 shows the Main Menu and Mimic screen. To select the Mimic screen from the  
Events, Meters, Controls, or Setup screens, press the pushbutton on the current menu  
bar.  
The Mimic screen shows the internal components of the UPS cabinet and a real-time  
graphical representation of the operating status of the system.  
TIME: 11 : 35 : 43  
INPUT  
DATE: 02 / 25 / 2004  
UPS  
BATT  
STSW  
CONTROLS  
SETUP  
OUTPUT  
BYPASS  
LOAD OFF  
EVENTS  
METERS  
Figure 9-3. Main Menu and Mimic Screen (Normal Mode)  
®
9-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
9.2.2 Event Screens  
Press the EVENTS pushbutton on the main menu bar or History Menu bar to display a  
listing of all system events that are currently active. The most recent event is listed first. As  
events clear, they are removed from the Active System Events listing. Figure 9-4 shows the  
Active Events screen.  
To scroll through the events, press the or pushbuttons on the menu bar.  
ACTIVE EVENTS  
ALARM:  
ALARM:  
INPUT AC UNDERVOLTAGE  
BYPASS AC UNDER VOLTAGE  
NOTICE: BATTERY VOLTAGE LOW  
NOTICE: NO SYNC ON  
NOTICE: BYPASS NOT AVAILABLE  
NOTICE: CONFIGURATION ERROR  
HISTORY  
Figure 9-4. Active Events Screen  
®
9-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Press the HISTORY pushbutton on the Active Events Menu bar to display the History Log.  
The History Log lists up to the 500 system events in chronological order, with the most  
recent event listed last (once 500 is reached, the earliest event is overwritten). The History  
Log lists the events in the following groups:  
Ī User and service status  
Ī User instruction  
Ī User alarm  
Ī Check UPS  
Ī Schedule service  
Ī UPS shutdown  
Ī Service alarm  
The end of the log (the most recent events) appears when you display the screen, and you  
must scroll upward to view older event listings. Figure 9-5 shows the History screen.  
To scroll through the events, press the or pushbuttons on the menu bar. To return to  
the Active Events screen, press the EVENTS pushbutton on the menu bar.  
HISTORY  
NOTICE: CONTROL POWER ON  
ALARM: BUILDING ALARM 1 OK  
NOTICE: NORMAL COMMAND  
NOTICE: TO BYPASS COMMAND  
UPS OFF  
02 / 26 / 2004  
EVENTS  
NOTICE:  
5 of 29  
10 : 20 : 03 . 539  
Figure 9-5. History Screen  
®
9-5  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
9.2.3 Unit Meter Screens  
The Unit Meter screens show the UPS meter readings for the unit (or units, if a parallel  
system is installed). The default voltage displayed on these screens is phase-to-neutral.  
However, an authorized Eaton Customer Service Engineer can change the screens to display  
the voltage phase-to-phase (A-B, B-C, C-A).  
Press the METERS pushbutton on the main menu bar to display the Unit Meter screens.  
Figure 9-6 through Figure 9-10 show the Unit Meter screens.  
To scroll through the meter screens, press the or pushbuttons on the menu bar. The  
current UPS readings are displayed in the information area of the screen.  
NOTE The UNIT designation after the meter type, and the SYSTEM and UNIT menu  
bar pushbutton selections, are visible only when a parallel system is installed.  
The Output screen shows output voltage (phase-to-neutral), output current (each phase),  
and frequency being supplied by the UPS, as well as the kVA, kW, and power factor  
measurements.  
OUTPUT --- UNIT  
V2  
V3  
KVA  
KW  
V1  
***  
***  
***  
***  
***  
I1  
***  
I2  
***  
I3  
***  
FREQ  
***  
PF  
***  
LEAD  
SYSTEM  
UNIT  
Figure 9-6. Unit Output Meter Screen  
®
9-6  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
The Input screen shows input voltage (phase-to-neutral), input current (each phase), and  
frequency of the incoming utility source, as well as the kVA, kW, and power factor  
measurements.  
INPUT --- UNIT  
V2  
V3  
KVA  
KW  
V1  
***  
***  
***  
***  
***  
I1  
***  
I2  
***  
I3  
***  
FREQ  
***  
PF  
***  
LEAD  
SYSTEM  
UNIT  
Figure 9-7. Unit Input Meter Screen  
The Bypass screen shows the bypass input voltage (phase-to-neutral), input current (each  
phase), and frequency of the incoming utility source, as well as the kVA, kW, and power  
factor measurements.  
BYPAS S --- UNIT  
V2  
V31  
KVA  
KW  
V1  
***  
***  
***  
***  
***  
I1  
***  
I2  
***  
I3  
***  
FREQ  
***  
PF  
***  
LEAD  
SYSTEM  
UNIT  
Figure 9-8. Unit Bypass Meter Screen  
®
9-7  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
The Battery screen displays the battery voltage (Vdc), the battery current (Idc), the minutes  
of battery time remaining, and battery temperature. Battery temperature must be set up  
by an authorized Eaton Customer Service Engineer. When battery life decreases to less than  
20%, Check Battery is displayed.  
BATTERY --- UNIT  
VDC  
V
***  
***  
***  
**  
IDC  
A
TIME REMAINING  
TEMPERATURE  
MINUTES  
DEGREES C  
SYSTEM  
UNIT  
Figure 9-9. Unit Battery Meter Screen  
The Output Current Screen displays a real-time bar graph of the output current of the UPS.  
The graph shows the current for each phase.  
OUTPUT CURRENT --- UNIT  
L1  
L2  
125%  
100%  
75%  
50%  
25%  
0%  
L3  
SYSTEM  
UNIT  
Figure 9-10. Unit Output Current (Load) Meter Screen  
®
9-8  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
9.2.4 Battery Discharge Log  
Press the METERS pushbutton on the main menu bar to display the Unit Meter screens.  
Scroll through the meter screens using the or pushbuttons on the menu bar until the  
Battery Discharge Log Summary screen is displayed.  
NOTE The Battery Discharge Log is available only when the mini-CSB is installed.  
The battery discharge log collects information when the unit is on battery. The Battery  
Discharge Log Summary screen displays the total number of times since the last log reset  
that the unit has transferred to battery. It also displays the date of the last log reset, the  
average time spent on battery per event, and the total time on battery since the last reset.  
Figure 9-11 shows the Battery Discharge Log Summary screen.  
BATTERY DISCHARGE LOG SUMMARY  
NUMBER OF TIMES ON BATTERY  
LAST LOG RESET  
1
07/28/2005  
** M ** S  
** H ** M  
AVERAGE TIME ON BATTERY  
TOTAL TIME ON BATTERY  
LOG  
Figure 9-11. Battery Discharge Log Summary Screen  
®
9-9  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Press the LOG pushbutton on the Battery Discharge Log Summary Menu bar to display the  
Battery Discharge Log screen.  
The Battery Discharge Log screen displays the individual log entries including the date and  
time of the event, how long it was on battery, the unit load when the event occurred, and  
the end voltage of the battery for that discharge period. If no events have occurred, the  
screen will display LOG EMPTY. Figure 9-12 shows the Battery Discharge Log screen.  
To scroll through the individual events, press the or pushbuttons on the menu bar. To  
return to the Battery Discharge Log Summary screen, press the SUMMARY pushbutton on  
the menu bar.  
To clear the Battery Discharge Log, press the RESET pushbutton on the menu bar.  
BATTERY DISCHARGE LOG  
BATTERY DISCHARGE EVENT  
DATE : 07/28/2005  
1/ 1  
TIME : 15 : 26 : 10  
** M ** S  
TIME ON BATTERY  
LOAD WHEN ON BATTERY  
END VOLTAGE :  
***.** KW  
***.** V  
RESET  
SUMMARY  
Figure 9-12. Battery Discharge Log Screen  
®
9-10  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
9.2.5 KW Demand Log  
Press the METERS pushbutton on the main menu bar to display the Unit Meter screens.  
Scroll through the meter screens using the or pushbuttons on the menu bar until the  
KW Demand Log Summary screen is displayed.  
NOTE The KW Demand Log is available only when the mini-CSB is installed.  
The KW demand log collects information on events where the unit load exceeds a  
user-defined KW limit within a user-defined time interval. The user can choose a time  
period up to 9999 minutes and a load limit up to 9999 KW. If the limit is exceeded within a  
given time period a log event is created. The KW Demand Log Summary screen displays the  
number of total times the limit has been exceeded since the last log reset, the date of the  
last log reset, the maximum KW reading, and the total time over the limit. It also displays  
the average KW over the limit and an estimated number of KWH used over the limit. Both  
of these values are calculated using the difference between the actual measurement  
reading and the user-defined limit level. For example, during a 60-minute interval if the  
limit is set at 10 KW and the measurement is a constant 15 KW for the entire period, the  
average KW over would be 5 KW and the total KWH used over the limit would be 5 KWH.  
Figure 9-13 shows the KW Demand Log Summary screen.  
KW DEMAND LOG SUMMARY  
NUMBER OF TIMES OVER LIMIT  
LAST LOG RESET  
12  
07/30/2005  
AVERAGE KW OVER LIMIT  
MAXIMUM READING (KW)  
TOTAL TIME OVER LIMIT  
TOTAL KWH USED OVER LIMIT  
LOG  
*** . ** KW  
*** . ** KW  
** MINUTES  
*** . ** KWH  
SETUP  
Figure 9-13. KW Demand Log Summary Screen  
®
9-11  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Press the LOG pushbutton on the KW Demand Log Summary Menu bar to display the KW  
Demand Log screen.  
The KW Demand Log screen displays the individual log entries, including the interval date  
and time frame, the maximum reading during the interval, the total time over limit during  
the interval, an estimated number of total KWH used during the interval, and the number  
of times over limit during the interval. If no events have occurred, the screen displays LOG  
EMPTY. Figure 9-14 shows the KW Demand Log screen.  
To scroll through the individual events, press the or pushbuttons on the menu bar. To  
return to the KW Demand Log Summary screen, press the SUMMARY pushbutton on the  
menu bar.  
To clear the KW Demand Log, press the RESET pushbutton on the menu bar.  
KW DEMAND LOG  
KW DEMAND EVENT  
INTERVAL : 07/30/2005  
MAXIMUM READING (KW)  
TIME OVER LIMIT  
6/ 12  
15 : 26 : 10 – 15 : 30 : 10  
*** . ** KW  
2 MINUTES  
KWH USED OVER LIMIT  
*** . **  
NUM TIMES OVER THIS INTERVAL  
3
RESET  
SUMMARY  
Figure 9-14. KW Demand Log Screen  
®
9-12  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Press the SETUP pushbutton on the KW Demand Log Summary Menu bar to display the  
Current KW Demand Log Setup screen 1.  
The Current KW Demand Log Setup screen 1 displays the current user-defined log settings.  
If no log settings are configured, the screen will display KW LOG DISABLED. Figure 9-15  
shows the Current KW Demand Log Setup screen 1.  
To return to the KW Demand Log Summary screen, press the  
menu bar.  
pushbutton on the  
CURRENT KW DEMAND LOG SETUP  
TIME INTERVAL MONITORED  
MAXIMUM LEVEL (KW)  
3 MINUTES  
*** KW  
CHANGE  
Figure 9-15. Current KW Demand Log Setup Screen 1  
®
9-13  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Press the CHANGE pushbutton on the Current KW Demand Log Setup Menu bar to display  
the Current KW Demand Log Setup screen 2.  
The Current KW Demand Log Setup screen can be used to set up or change the time  
interval and maximum level log settings. Figure 9-16 shows the Current KW Demand Log  
Setup screen 2.  
Use the or pushbuttons to highlight the setup function screen desired, then press the  
SELECT pushbutton to display the function screen.  
To return to the Current KW Demand Log Setup screen 1, press the  
the menu bar.  
pushbutton on  
CURRENT KW DEMAND LOG SETUP  
TIME INTERVAL MONITORED  
MAXIMUM LEVEL (KW)  
SELECT  
Figure 9-16. Current KW Demand Log Setup Screen 2  
®
9-14  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Select TIME INTERVAL MONITORED from the Current KW Demand Log Setup screen 2  
menu to display the Time Interval Monitored Setup screen. The Time Interval Monitored  
Setup screen allows the time duration of the event being monitored to be changed.  
Figure 9-17 shows the Time Interval Monitored Setup screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to select the character position. Use the or pushbuttons  
to change the character value. Once the new value is entered, press the DONE  
pushbutton. The Time Interval Monitored Setup Save screen is displayed.  
TIME INTERVAL MONITORED SETUP  
0000  
DONE  
Figure 9-17. Time Interval Monitored Setup Screen  
®
9-15  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
The Time Interval Monitored Setup Save screen lets you save the new time interval, retry  
another time interval, or abort the change. Figure 9-18 shows the Time Interval Monitored  
Setup Save screen.  
Press SAVE, RETRY, or ABORT. If SAVE or ABORT is pressed, the action is completed, and  
the Current KW Demand Log Setup screen 2 displays. If RETRY is pressed, the Time Interval  
Monitored Setup screen is redisplayed.  
TIME INTERVAL MONITORED SETUP  
0000  
ABORT  
SAVE  
RETRY  
Figure 9-18. Time Interval Monitored Setup Save Screen  
®
9-16  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Select MAXIMUM LEVEL (KW) from the Current KW Demand Log Setup screen 2 menu to  
display the Maximum Level (KW) Setup screen. The Maximum Level (KW) Setup screen  
allows the KW limit of the event being monitored to be changed. Figure 9-19 shows the  
Maximum Level (KW) Setup screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to select the character position. Use the or pushbuttons  
to change the character value. Once the new value is entered, press the DONE  
pushbutton. The Maximum Level (KW) Setup Save screen is displayed.  
MAXIMUM LEVEL (KW) SETUP  
0000  
DONE  
Figure 9-19. Maximum Level (KW) Setup Screen  
®
9-17  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
The Maximum Level (KW) Setup Save screen lets you save the new KW limit, retry another  
KW limit, or abort the change. Figure 9-20 shows the Maximum Level (KW) Setup Save  
screen.  
Press SAVE, RETRY, or ABORT. If SAVE or ABORT is pressed, the action is completed, and  
the Current KW Demand Log Setup screen 2 displays. If RETRY is pressed, the Maximum  
Level (KW) Setup screen is redisplayed.  
MAXIMUM LEVEL (KW) SETUP  
0000  
ABORT  
SAVE  
RETRY  
Figure 9-20. Maximum Level (KW) Setup Save Screen  
®
9-18  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
9.2.6 Maximum Current Log  
Press the METERS pushbutton on the main menu bar to display the Unit Meter screens.  
Scroll through the meter screens using the or pushbuttons on the menu bar until the  
Maximum Current Log Summary screen is displayed.  
NOTE The Maximum Current Log is available only when the mini-CSB is installed.  
The maximum current log collects information on events where the unit load exceeds a  
user-defined current limit within a user-defined time interval. The user can choose a time  
period up to 9999 minutes and a load limit up to 100%. The user can also select whether  
the limit defined is a three-phase average of the individual phase currents or is a limit  
defined for each phase individually. In the first case an event is logged if the average across  
the phases exceeds the defined limit within a given time period and in the second case an  
event is logged if any individual phase exceeds the defined limit within a given time period.  
The Maximum Current Log Summary screen displays the number of times the limit has  
been exceeded, the date of the last log reset, the maximum percent of full load, and the  
total time over the limit. It also displays the average percent load over the limit. This  
measurement differs, depending on whether a three-phase average or an individual phase  
measurement is selected. Figure 9-21 shows the Maximum Current Log Summary screen.  
MAXIMUM CURRENT LOG SUMMARY  
NUMBER OF TIMES OVER LIMIT  
LAST LOG RESET  
5
08/04/2005  
*** . ** %  
AVERAGE % OF FULL LOAD  
MAXIMUM % OF FULL LOAD  
TOTAL TIME OVER LIMIT  
*** . ** %  
** MINUTES  
SETUP  
LOG  
Figure 9-21. Maximum Current Log Summary Screen  
®
9-19  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Press the LOG pushbutton on the Maximum Current Log Summary Menu bar to display the  
Maximum Current Log screen.  
The Maximum Current Log screen displays the individual log entries, including the interval  
date and time frame, the maximum percent of full load during the interval, the total time  
over limit during the interval, and the number of times over during the interval. If the  
individual phase option is selected, the phases that exceeded the limit will also be  
displayed. If no events have occurred, the screen will display LOG EMPTY. Figure 9-22 and  
Figure 9-23 show the Maximum Current Log screens.  
To scroll through the individual events, press the or pushbuttons on the menu bar. To  
return to the Maximum Current Log Summary screen, press the SUMMARY pushbutton on  
the menu bar.  
To clear the Maximum Current Log, press the RESET pushbutton on the menu bar.  
MAXIMUM CURRENT LOG  
MAXIMUM CURRENT EVENT  
INTERVAL : 07/30/2005  
2/ 5  
15 : 26 : 10 – 15 : 30 : 10  
*** . ** %  
MAXIMUM % OF FULL LOAD  
TIME OVER LIMIT  
2 MINUTES  
NUM TIMES OVER THIS INTERVAL  
3
RESET  
SUMMARY  
Figure 9-22. Maximum Current Log Screen (Three-Phase Measurement)  
®
9-20  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
MAXIMUM CURRENT LOG  
MAXIMUM CURRENT EVENT  
2/ 5  
15 : 26 : 10 – 15 : 30 : 10  
*** . ** %  
INTERVAL : 07/30/2005  
MAXIMUM % OF FULL LOAD  
TIME OVER LIMIT  
2 MINUTES  
NUM TIMES OVER THIS INTERVAL  
PHASES OVER THIS INTERVAL  
3
1 2  
RESET  
SUMMARY  
Figure 9-23. Maximum Current Log Screen (Individual Phase Measurement)  
Press the SETUP pushbutton on the Maximum Current Log Summary Menu bar to display  
the Maximum Current Log Setup screen 1.  
The Maximum Current Log Setup screen 1 displays the current user defined log settings. If  
no log settings are configured, the screen will display MAXIMUM CURRENT LOG DISABLED.  
Figure 9-24 shows the Maximum Current Log Setup screen 1.  
To return to the Maximum Current Log Summary screen, press the  
menu bar.  
pushbutton on the  
MAXIMUM CURRENT LOG SETUP  
TIME INTERVAL MONITORED  
3 MINUTES  
*** %  
MAXIMUM % OF FULL LOAD  
LEVEL BASED ON 3 PHASE AVERAGE  
CHANGE  
Figure 9-24. Maximum Current Log Setup Screen 1  
®
9-21  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Press the CHANGE pushbutton on the Maximum Current Log Setup Menu bar to display  
the Maximum Current Log Setup screen 2.  
The Maximum Current Log Setup screen can be used to set up or change the time interval,  
the maximum percent of load, and the calculation method (three-phase average or  
individual phases) log settings. Figure 9-25 shows the Maximum Current Log Setup  
screen 2.  
Use the or pushbuttons to highlight the setup function screen desired, then press the  
SELECT pushbutton to display the function screen.  
To return to the Maximum Current Log Setup screen 1, press the  
menu bar.  
pushbutton on the  
MAXIMUM CURRENT LOG SETUP  
TIME INTERVAL MONITORED  
MAXIMUM % OF FULL LOAD  
CALCULATION METHOD  
SELECT  
Figure 9-25. Maximum Current Log Setup Screen 2  
®
9-22  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Select TIME INTERVAL MONITORED from the Maximum Current Log Setup screen 2  
menu to display the Time Interval Monitored Setup screen. The Time Interval Monitored  
Setup screen allows the time duration of the event being monitored to be changed.  
Figure 9-26 shows the Time Interval Monitored Setup screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to select the character position. Use the or pushbuttons  
to change the character value. Once the new value is entered, press the DONE  
pushbutton. The Time Interval Monitored Setup Save screen is displayed.  
TIME INTERVAL MONITORED SETUP  
0000  
DONE  
Figure 9-26. Time Interval Monitored Setup Screen  
®
9-23  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
The Time Interval Monitored Setup Save screen lets you save the new time interval, retry  
another time interval, or abort the change. Figure 9-18 shows the Time Interval Monitored  
Setup Save screen.  
Press SAVE, RETRY, or ABORT. If SAVE or ABORT is pressed, the action is completed, and  
the Maximum Current Log Setup screen 2 displays. If RETRY is pressed, the Time Interval  
Monitored Setup screen is redisplayed.  
TIME INTERVAL MONITORED SETUP  
0000  
ABORT  
SAVE  
RETRY  
Figure 9-27. Time Interval Monitored Setup Save Screen  
®
9-24  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Select MAXIMUM % of FULL LOAD from the Maximum Current Log Setup screen  
(screen 2) menu to display the Maximum % of Full Load Setup screen. The Maximum % of  
Full Load Setup screen allows the full load limit of the event being monitored to be  
changed. Figure 9-28 shows the Maximum % of Full Load Setup screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to select the character position. Use the or pushbuttons  
to change the character value. Once the new value is entered, press the DONE  
pushbutton. The Maximum % of Full Load Setup Save screen is displayed.  
MAXIMUM % OF FULL LOAD SETUP  
000  
DONE  
Figure 9-28. Maximum % of Full Load Setup Screen  
®
9-25  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
The Maximum % of Full Load Setup Save screen lets you save the new load limit, retry  
another load limit, or abort the change. Figure 9-29 shows the Maximum % of Full Load  
Setup Save screen.  
Press SAVE, RETRY, or ABORT. If SAVE or ABORT is pressed, the action is completed, and  
the Maximum Current Log Setup screen 2 displays. If RETRY is pressed, the Maximum % of  
Full Load Setup screen is redisplayed.  
MAXIMUM % OF FULL LOAD SETUP  
000  
ABORT  
SAVE  
RETRY  
Figure 9-29. Maximum % of Full Load Setup Save Screen  
®
9-26  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Select CALCULATION METHOD from the Maximum Current Log Setup screen 2 menu to  
display the Calculation Method Setup screen. The Calculation Method Setup screen allows  
the full load limit of the event being monitored to be changed. Figure 9-30 shows the  
Calculation Method Setup screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to highlight the calculation method desired, then press the  
SELECT pushbutton. The action is completed, and the Maximum Current Log Setup  
screen 2 displays.  
To return to the Maximum Current Log Setup screen 1, press the  
menu bar.  
pushbutton on the  
MAXIMUM CURRENT LOG SETUP  
LEVEL BASED ON 3 PHASE AVERAGE  
LEVEL BASED ON INDIVIDUAL PHASES  
SELECT  
Figure 9-30. Calculation Method Setup Screen  
®
9-27  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
9.2.7 System Meters Screens  
The System Meters screens show the total system and individual UPS unit meter readings  
from any unit, when a parallel system is installed. The default voltage displayed on these  
screens is phase-to-neutral. However, an authorized Eaton Customer Service Engineer can  
change the screens to display the voltage phase-to-phase (A-B, B-C, C-A).  
Press the METERS pushbutton on the main menu bar to display the Unit Meter screens.  
Press the SYSTEM pushbutton on the menu bar to display the System Meters screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to highlight the Total System meter or Unit meters desired,  
then press the SELECT pushbutton to display the screen.  
SYSTEM METERS  
TOTAL SYSTEM  
UNIT 1  
UNIT 2  
ENTER PASS-  
UNIT 3  
WORD  
UNIT 4  
SELECT  
Figure 9-31. System Meters Screen  
®
9-28  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
The Output Total System screen shows output voltage (phase-to-neutral), output current  
(each phase), and frequency being supplied by the UPS, as well as the kVA, kW, and power  
factor measurements for the total system. The displayed voltages and frequency are the  
highest measured value of all units. The displayed currents, kVA, and kW are totals of all  
units, and the PF is calculated from the total values for the kVA and kW.  
OUTPUT TOTAL SYSTEM  
V2  
V3  
KVA  
KW  
V1  
***  
***  
***  
***  
***  
I1  
***  
I2  
***  
I3  
***  
FREQ  
***  
PF  
***  
LEAD  
SYSTEM  
UNIT  
Figure 9-32. Total System Output Meter Screen  
®
9-29  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Figure 9-33 through Figure 9-37 show the System Meters screens. To scroll through the  
meter screens, press the or pushbuttons on the menu bar. The current UPS readings  
for the selected unit are displayed in the information area of the screen. To return to the  
present Unit Meter screens, press the UNIT pushbutton on the menu bar.  
NOTE In the following figures, “X” equals the unit number selected from the System  
Meters screen.  
The Output screen shows output voltage (phase-to-neutral), output current (each phase),  
and frequency being supplied by the UPS, as well as the kVA, kW, and power factor  
measurements for the selected unit.  
OUTPUT UNIT X  
V2  
V3  
KVA  
KW  
V1  
***  
***  
***  
***  
***  
I1  
***  
I2  
***  
I3  
***  
FREQ  
***  
PF  
***  
LEAD  
SYSTEM  
UNIT  
Figure 9-33. Output Unit X Meter Screen  
®
9-30  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
The Input screen shows input voltage (phase-to-neutral), output current (each phase), and  
frequency of the incoming utility source, as well as the kVA, kW, and power factor  
measurements for the selected unit.  
INPUT UNIT X  
V2  
V3  
KVA  
KW  
V1  
***  
***  
***  
***  
***  
I1  
***  
I2  
***  
I3  
***  
FREQ  
***  
PF  
***  
LEAD  
SYSTEM  
UNIT  
Figure 9-34. Input Unit X Meter Screen  
The Bypass screen shows the bypass input voltage (phase-to-neutral), output current (each  
phase), and frequency of the incoming utility source, as well as the kVA, kW, and power  
factor measurements for the selected unit.  
BYPASS UNIT X  
V2  
V3  
KVA  
KW  
V1  
***  
***  
***  
***  
***  
I1  
***  
I2  
***  
I3  
***  
FREQ  
***  
PF  
***  
LEAD  
SYSTEM  
UNIT  
Figure 9-35. Bypass Unit X Meter Screen  
®
9-31  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
The Battery screen displays the battery voltage (Vdc), the battery current (Idc), the minutes  
of battery time remaining, and battery temperature. Battery temperature must be set up  
by an authorized Eaton Customer Service Engineer When battery life decreases to less  
than 20%, Check Battery is displayed.  
BATTERY UNIT X  
VDC  
V
***  
***  
***  
**  
IDC  
A
TIME REMAINING  
TEMPERATURE  
MINUTES  
DEGREES C  
SYSTEM  
UNIT  
Figure 9-36. Battery Unit X Meter Screen  
The Output Current screen displays a real-time bar graph of the output current of the UPS  
for the selected unit. The graph shows the current for each phase.  
OUTPUT CURRENT UNIT X  
L1  
L2  
125%  
100%  
75%  
50%  
25%  
0%  
L3  
SYSTEM  
UNIT  
Figure 9-37. Output Current (Load) Unit X Meter Screen  
®
9-32  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
9.2.8 System Setup Level 0 Screens  
Press the SETUP pushbutton on the main menu bar to display the System Setup Level 0  
Screen. This screen can be used to:  
Ī Enter a password to access Level 1 functions (see paragraph 9.2.9)  
No password is necessary to access Level 0 functions.  
Ī Set the screen contrast  
Ī Show the firmware versions installed  
Ī Identify the unit type  
Figure 9-38 shows the System Setup Level 0 menu screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to highlight the setup function screen desired, then press the  
SELECT pushbutton to display the function screen.  
SYSTEM SETUP LEVEL 0  
ENTER PASSWORD  
CONTRAST ADJUST  
VERSIONS  
UNIT TYPE  
SELECT  
Figure 9-38. System Setup Level 0 Screen  
®
9-33  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Select CONTRAST from the System Setup Level 0 menu to display the Contrast Adjust  
screen. Figure 9-39 shows the Contrast Adjust screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to adjust the contrast for the LCD. When the contrast  
adjustment is complete, press the SAVE pushbutton. Once the setting is saved, the System  
Setup screen displays. To return to the System Setup screen without saving the setting,  
press the  
pushbutton.  
CONTRAST ADJUST  
70%  
SAVE  
Figure 9-39. Contrast Adjust Screen  
®
9-34  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Select VERSIONS from the System Setup Level 0 menu to display the Versions screen. The  
Versions screen provides the firmware version numbers installed on the UPS. Figure 9-40  
shows the Versions screen.  
To scroll through the firmware types, press the or pushbuttons on the menu bar. To  
return to the System Setup screen, press the  
pushbutton.  
VERSIONS  
DSP  
57.00  
0.54  
3.00  
0.00  
1
DISPLAY  
MINI CSB  
GATE DRIVE  
PLD  
BOOTLOADER  
0.00  
Figure 9-40. Versions Screen  
Select UNIT TYPE from the System Setup Level 0 menu to display the Unit Type screen.  
The Unit Type screen provides the model, CTO, and serial numbers of the UPS unit.  
Figure 9-41 shows the Unit Type screen. To return to the System Setup screen, press the  
pushbutton.  
UNIT TYPE  
MODEL:  
CTO:  
POWERWARE 9390  
0000000000000000  
0000000000000000  
SERIAL:  
Figure 9-41. Unit Type Screen  
®
9-35  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
9.2.9 System Setup Level 1 Screens  
A password is required to access the Level 1 functions. To enter the password, select  
ENTER PASSWORD from the System Setup Level 0 menu to display the Enter Password  
screen. Figure 9-42 shows the Enter Password screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to select the password character position. Use the or  
pushbuttons to change the password character. Once the password is entered, press the  
DONE pushbutton. The System Setup Level 1 menu screen is displayed. The default  
password is L1.  
ENTER PASSWORD  
L1  
DONE  
Figure 9-42. Enter Password Screen  
®
9-36  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
The System Setup Level 1 screen can be used to set the UPS date and time, set the serial  
ports, change the Level 1 password, and log out of Level 1. In addition, the Level 0  
functions are available. Figure 9-43 shows the System Setup Level 1 screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to highlight the setup function screen desired, then press the  
SELECT pushbutton to display the function screen.  
The Level 1 screen times out after 60 minutes or can be logged out at any time by  
selecting the LOG OUT function from the menu screen.  
SYSTEM SETUP LEVEL 1  
LOG OUT  
ENTER PASSWORD  
CHANGE PASSWORD  
ENTER PASS-  
CONTRAST ADJUST  
WORD  
VERSIONS  
UNIT TYPE  
SELECT  
Figure 9-43. System Setup Level 1 Screen  
®
9-37  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Select CHANGE PASSWORD from the System Setup Level 1 menu to display the Change  
Password screen. The Change Password screen allows the System Setup Level 1 password to  
be changed. Figure 9-44 shows the Change Password screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to select the password character position. Use the or  
pushbuttons to change the password character. Once the new password is entered, press  
the DONE pushbutton. The Change Password Save screen is displayed.  
CHANGE PASSWORD  
OLD:  
NEW:  
L1  
L1  
DONE  
Figure 9-44. Change Password Screen  
®
9-38  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
The Change Password Save screen lets you save the new password, retry another password,  
or abort the password change. Figure 9-45 shows the Change Password Save screen.  
Press SAVE, RETRY, or ABORT. If SAVE or ABORT is pressed, the action is completed, and  
the System Setup screen displays. If RETRY is pressed, the Change Password screen is  
redisplayed.  
CHANGE PASSWORD  
OLD:  
L1  
L1  
NEW:  
ABORT  
SAVE  
RETRY  
Figure 9-45. Change Password Save Screen  
®
9-39  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Select DATE AND TIME from the System Setup Level 1 menu to display the Time Format  
Setup screen. The Time Format Setup screen allows the selection of either month/day/year  
or day/month/year formats for display on the screen and for logging events in the Event  
and History Logs. Figure 9-46 shows the Time Format screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to highlight the desired format, then press the SELECT  
pushbutton to display the Set Date and Time screen. To return to the System Setup screen,  
press the  
pushbutton.  
TIME FORMAT SETUP  
MM/DD/YYYY  
DD/MM/YYYY  
SELECT  
Figure 9-46. Time Format Screen  
®
9-40  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
The Set Date and Time MM/DD/YYYY screen allows the internal date and time of the UPS  
to be set in the month/day/year format. The date and time information is used for display  
on the screen and for logging events in the Event and History Logs. Figure 9-47 shows the  
Set Date and Time MM/DD/YYYY screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to highlight the setting to be changed. Use the or  
pushbuttons to make the change. When finished making changes, use the or  
pushbuttons to highlight SAVE and the or pushbuttons to select YES. To complete the  
save function and return to the System Setup screen, select the  
pushbutton.  
SET DATE AND TIME MM/DD/YYYY  
MONTH DATE YEAR HOUR MINUTE SAVE  
02 27 2004 15 42 YES  
Figure 9-47. Set Date and Time MM/DD/YYYY Screen  
®
9-41  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
The Set Date and Time DD/MM/YYYY screen allows the internal date and time of the UPS  
to be set in the day/month/year format. The date and time information is used for display  
on the screen and for logging events in the Event and History Logs. Figure 9-48 shows the  
Set Date and Time DD/MM/YYYY screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to highlight the setting to be changed. Use the or  
pushbuttons to make the change. When finished making changes, use the or  
pushbuttons to highlight SAVE and the or pushbuttons to select YES. To complete the  
save function and return to the System Setup screen, select the  
pushbutton.  
SET DATE AND TIME DD/MM/YYYY  
DATE MONTH YEAR HOUR MINUTE SAVE  
27 02 2004 15 42 YES  
Figure 9-48. Set Date and Time DD/MM/YYYY Screen  
®
9-42  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
Select COM PORT SETUP from the System Setup Level 1 menu to display the COM Port  
Setup screen. This screen allows selection of the serial COM port to set up. Figure 9-49  
shows the COM Port Setup screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to highlight the the COM port to be set up, then press the  
SELECT pushbutton. To return to the System Setup screen, press the  
pushbutton.  
COM PORT SETUP  
COM 1  
COM 2  
COM 3  
SELECT  
Figure 9-49. COM Port Setup Screen  
®
9-43  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
The COM Setup screen is used to change and save the settings for the serial  
communication ports. The COM port number selected from the COM Port Setup screen  
displays. If the changes are not wanted, use the ABORT pushbutton to return to the COM  
Port Setup screen. Figure 9-50 shows the COM Setup screen.  
Use the or pushbuttons to highlight the setting to be changed. Use the pushbutton  
to toggle through the values for the setting to make the change. Press SAVE or ABORT.  
Once the action is completed, the COM Port Setup screen appears.  
COM 1 SETUP  
BAUD RATE  
19200  
DATA BITS  
STOP BITS  
PARITY  
8
1
NONE  
ABORT  
SAVE  
Figure 9-50. COM Setup Screen  
®
9-44  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
9.3 System Controls Screen  
Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar to display the System Controls  
screen. LOAD OFF, normal operation, transfer to bypass, charger control, and power  
module startup and shutdown functions are controlled from this screen. In addition, the  
screen displays the current status of the UPS and indicates whether the UPS is in  
Maintenance Bypass or Bypass, and the state of the power module (PM) and battery  
charger. Figure 9-51 and Figure 9-52 show the System Controls screens.  
Use the or pushbutton on the menu bar to toggle the menu bar functions between  
the two System Controls screens.  
SYSTEM CONTROLS  
MAINTENANCE BYPASS  
BYPASS  
POWER MODULE (PM)  
CHARGER  
: OFF  
: OFF  
: ONLINE  
: OFF  
LOAD OFF NORMAL  
BYPASS  
Figure 9-51. System Controls Screen 1  
®
9-45  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
SYSTEM CONTROLS  
MAINTENANCE BYPASS  
: OFF  
BYPASS  
: OFF  
: ONLINE  
: OFF  
POWER MODULE (PM)  
CHARGER  
LOAD OFF CHGR ON PM OFF  
Figure 9-52. System Controls Screen 2  
The CHGR pushbutton switch toggles the charger function On and Off. The PM pushbutton  
switch toggles the power module function On and Off.  
For detailed information about using the System Controls, see Chapter 10, “UPS Operating  
Instructions.”  
®
9-46  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
9.4 Load Off Screen  
The Load Off screen appears when the LOAD OFF pushbutton is selected from the main  
menu bar or System Controls menu bar. This screen allows the LOAD OFF process to be  
aborted if the LOAD OFF pushbutton was pressed accidentally. Figure 9-53 shows the Load  
Off screen. For detailed information about using the LOAD OFF and Shutdown screens, see  
Chapter 10, “UPS Operating Instructions.”  
HOLD LOAD OFF BUTTON FOR 3 SECONDS  
TO TURN OFF LOAD  
CANCEL  
LOAD OFF  
Figure 9-53. Load Off Screen  
®
9-47  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Control Panel  
9.5 Reading the Status Indicators  
The four symbols on the right side of the control panel are status indicators. They are  
colored light emitting diode (LED) lamps, and they work in conjunction with the alarm  
horn to let you know the operating status of the UPS.  
Normal  
This green indicator is illuminated when the UPS is operating  
in Normal mode. The power module is supplying power to  
the critical load.  
The indicator flashes when the system needs attention. The  
LCD shows all active notices. Some notices may be  
accompanied by an audible horn. To silence the horn, press  
any control panel pushbutton once. The indicator may be  
flashing while other indicators are illuminated. The indicator  
continues to flash until acknowledged by pressing any  
control panel pushbutton once.  
Battery  
Bypass  
This yellow indicator is illuminated when the UPS is operating  
in Battery mode. Because Battery mode is a normal condition  
of the UPS, the Normal indicator also remains illuminated.  
This yellow indicator is illuminated when the UPS is operating  
in Bypass mode. The critical load is supported by the bypass  
source. The Normal indicator is not illuminated when the  
system is in Bypass mode.  
Alarm  
This red indicator is illuminated when a situation requires  
immediate attention. The LCD shows the highest priority  
active alarms. All alarms are accompanied by an audible  
horn. To silence the horn, press any control panel  
pushbutton once. The Alarm indicator may be illuminated  
along with other indicators. The indicator flashes until  
acknowledged by pressing any control panel pushbutton  
once.  
For more information about audible horns, see “System Event Horns” on page 12-1.  
®
9-48  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 10 UPS Operating Instructions  
The following procedures provide instructions for operating the UPS or parallel system. For  
a description of the UPS control panel functions, see Chapter 9, “Using the Control Panel.”  
NOTE Before starting the UPS or parallel system, ensure all installation tasks are  
complete and a preliminary startup has been performed by authorized service  
personnel. The preliminary startup verifies all electrical interconnections to ensure the  
installation was successful and the system operates properly.  
NOTE Read this section of the manual and have thorough knowledge of parallel and  
UPS operation before attempting to operate any of the controls.  
NOTE The UPS displays two minutes of battery runtime at the initial startup. After a  
24-hour charging period, the UPS automatically runs a battery test and the correct  
battery runtime displays.  
10.1 Single Module Operation  
10.1.1 Starting the UPS in Normal Mode  
To start the UPS system, perform the following procedure:  
1. Close the UPS input feeder circuit breaker.  
2. If the UPS is dual feed, close the UPS Bypass input feeder circuit breaker.  
3. Observe the UPS control panel display becoming active, indicating logic power.  
4. Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar. The System Controls  
screen appears.  
5. On the System Controls screen, the power module (PM) status should indicate  
SHUTDOWN.  
6. Press the NORMAL pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar.  
If Auto Bypass is enabled, the critical load is immediately supplied by the bypass  
source, in Bypass mode, until the inverter turns on and the UPS transfers to  
Normal mode. The status indicator on the UPS control panel indicates the UPS is  
in Bypass mode. If Auto Bypass is not enabled, the UPS output remains off until  
the UPS transfers to Normal mode.  
®
10-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Operating Instructions  
7. Observe the following messages appear sequentially on the power module (PM)  
status line:  
DC STARTING  
INVERTER STARTING  
INVERTER SYNCING  
READY  
ONLINE  
The rectifier and inverter turn on. The inverter continues to ramp up to full  
voltage.  
8. Close the battery breaker any time after INVERTER SYNCING or CLOSE BATTERY  
appears on the display.  
Once the inverter reaches full voltage, and the battery breaker is closed, the UPS  
output contactor K3 closes and the static switch turns off. Power is now supplied  
to the critical load in Normal mode. It takes approximately 1 minute for the UPS  
to achieve Normal mode.  
9. The UPS is now operating in Normal mode and the NORMAL status indicator is  
illuminated.  
10.1.2 Starting the UPS in Bypass Mode  
If the inverter output of the UPS is not available and the critical load needs to be  
energized, perform the following procedure:  
C A U T I O N  
In Bypass mode, the critical load is not protected from commercial power interruptions and  
abnormalities.  
1. Close the UPS input feeder circuit breaker.  
2. If the UPS is dual feed, close the UPS Bypass input feeder circuit breaker.  
3. Observe the UPS control panel becoming active, indicating logic power.  
4. Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar. The System Controls  
screen appears.  
5. On the System Controls screen, the power module (PM) status should indicate  
SHUTDOWN.  
6. Press the BYPASS pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar.  
The critical load is immediately supplied by the bypass source, in Bypass mode.  
7. The UPS is now operating in Bypass mode and the BYPASS status indicator is  
illuminated.  
®
10-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Operating Instructions  
10.1.3 Starting the Power Module  
To start the power module without transferring the critical load to normal, perform the  
following procedure:  
1. Close the UPS input feeder circuit breaker.  
2. If the UPS is dual feed, close the UPS Bypass input feeder circuit breaker.  
3. Observe the UPS control panel becoming active, indicating logic power.  
4. Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar. The System Controls  
screen appears.  
5. On the System Controls screen, the power module (PM) status should indicate  
SHUTDOWN.  
6. Press the pushbutton to display System Controls Screen 2.  
7. Press the PM ON pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar.  
8. Observe the following messages appear sequentially on the power module (PM)  
status line:  
DC STARTING  
INVERTER STARTING  
INVERTER SYNCING  
READY  
The rectifier and inverter turn on. When the inverter reaches full voltage, the UPS  
is ready to transfer to the Normal mode and supply the critical load.  
10.1.4 Transfer from Normal to Bypass Mode  
To transfer the critical load to Bypass mode, perform the following procedure:  
C A U T I O N  
In Bypass mode, the critical load is not protected from commercial power interruptions and  
abnormalities.  
1. Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar. The System Controls  
screen appears.  
2. Press the BYPASS pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar.  
The UPS transfers to Bypass mode and the critical load is immediately supplied by  
the bypass source. If the bypass source is not available, the power processor  
remains on and an alarm sounds.  
®
10-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Operating Instructions  
3. The UPS is now operating in Bypass mode and the BYPASS status indicator is  
illuminated.  
The power module (PM) status indicates READY. The system is now on bypass and  
the UPS power processor remains on.  
W A R N I N G  
Power is present inside the UPS cabinets.  
10.1.5 Transfer from Bypass to Normal Mode  
To transfer the critical load to Normal mode, perform the following procedure:  
1. Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar. The System Controls  
screen appears.  
2. Press the NORMAL pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar.  
The UPS transfers to Normal mode. If the power processor is not available, the  
system remains on bypass and an alarm sounds.  
3. The UPS is now operating in Normal mode, and the NORMAL status indicator is  
illuminated.  
The power module (PM) status indicates ONLINE.  
10.1.6 Transfer from Normal to Bypass Mode and Shut Down UPS  
To transfer the critical load to Bypass mode and shut down the UPS, perform the following  
procedure:  
1. Transfer the critical load to bypass by performing the procedure in  
paragraph 10.1.4.  
2. Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar. The System Control  
screen appears.  
3. Press the pushbutton to display System Controls Screen 2.  
4. Press the PM OFF pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar.  
The power module (PM) status indicates SHUTDOWN. The input and output  
contactors open, the battery breaker or disconnect is tripped, and the power  
module is turned off. The bypass source supplies the critical load.  
W A R N I N G  
Power is present inside the UPS cabinets.  
®
10-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Operating Instructions  
10.1.7 UPS and Critical Load Shutdown  
To perform maintenance or service on the critical load, shut down power to the load by  
performing the following procedure:  
1. Turn off all equipment that is being powered by the UPS.  
2. Perform the LOAD OFF procedure in paragraph 10.1.9.  
The input, output, and bypass backfeed contactors open, the battery breaker or  
disconnect is tripped, and the power module is turned off.  
W A R N I N G  
Power is present inside the UPS cabinet until the upstream input feeder circuit breaker is  
opened.  
3. Open the UPS input and bypass (if dual feed) feeder circuit breakers.  
10.1.8 Charger Control  
To turn the battery charger on or off, perform the following procedure:  
1. Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar. The System Control  
screen appears.  
2. Press the pushbutton to display System Controls Screen 2.  
3. Press the CHGR ON or CHGR OFF pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar  
to toggle the charger on or off.  
®
10-5  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Operating Instructions  
10.1.9 Using the UPS LOAD OFF Pushbutton  
A UPS Load Off is initiated by the LOAD OFF pushbutton from the main menu bar or the  
System Controls menu bar. This pushbutton can be pressed to control the UPS output. The  
UPS LOAD OFF pushbutton de-energizes the critical load and powers down the UPS.  
The UPS (including Bypass) remains off until restarted.  
To use the LOAD OFF pushbutton:  
1. Press the LOAD OFF pushbutton.  
The Load Off screen appears, providing a choice to proceed or abort the  
shutdown.  
C A U T I O N  
All power to the critical load is lost when the LOAD OFF is selected in the following step. You  
should use this feature only when you want to de-energize the critical load.  
2. To shut down the UPS, press LOAD OFF from the Load Off menu bar, and hold for  
three seconds. To abort the shutdown, press CANCEL.  
When LOAD OFF is selected and held for three seconds, the input, output, and  
bypass backfeed contactors open, the battery breaker or disconnect is tripped,  
and the power module is turned off.  
C A U T I O N  
Do not attempt to restart the system after Load Off until the cause of the shutdown has been  
identified and cleared.  
3. To restart the UPS after pressing the LOAD OFF pushbutton, follow the procedure  
in paragraph 10.1.1 or 10.1.2.  
®
10-6  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Operating Instructions  
10.1.10 Using the Remote Emergency Power-off Switch  
A UPS emergency power-off is initiated by the REPO pushbutton switch. In an emergency,  
you can use this switch to control the UPS output. The REPO switch de-energizes the  
critical load and powers down the UPS immediately, without asking for verification.  
The UPS, including Bypass, remains off until restarted.  
C A U T I O N  
All power to the critical load is lost when the REPO switch is activated in the following step.  
You should use this feature only when you want to de-energize the critical load.  
NOTE The following instructions are for the Powerware-supplied REPO switch. If a  
customer-supplied REPO switch is used, it may not activate in the same manner; refer  
to the operating instructions provided with the switch.  
To use the REPO switch:  
1. Press the REPO pushbutton switch.  
The input, output, and bypass backfeed contactors open, the battery breaker or  
disconnect is tripped, and the power module is turned off immediately, without  
asking for verification.  
C A U T I O N  
Do not attempt to restart the system after Load Off until the cause of the shutdown has been  
identified and cleared.  
2. To restart the UPS after using the REPO pushbutton, reset the REPO switch and  
then follow the procedure in paragraph 10.1.1 or 10.1.2.  
®
10-7  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Operating Instructions  
10.2 Multiple Module Parallel Operation  
10.2.1 Starting the Parallel System in Normal Mode  
To start the parallel system, perform the following procedure:  
1. Close all uninterruptible power module input feeder circuit breakers.  
2. If the UPMs are dual feed, close all UPM Bypass input feeder circuit breakers.  
3. Observe all UPM control panel displays becoming active, indicating logic power.  
4. Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar of any UPM. The System  
Controls screen appears on each UPM.  
5. On the System Controls screen of each UPM, the power module (PM) status  
should indicate SHUTDOWN.  
6. Press the NORMAL pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar of any UPM.  
If Auto Bypass is enabled, the critical load is immediately supplied by the bypass  
source, in Bypass mode, until the inverters turn on and the UPMs transfer to  
Normal mode. The status indicator on each UPM control panel indicates the UPM  
is in Bypass mode. If Auto Bypass is not enabled, the UPM outputs remain off until  
the UPMs transfer to Normal mode.  
7. Observe the following messages appear sequentially on the power module (PM)  
status line of each UPM:  
DC STARTING  
INVERTER STARTING  
INVERTER SYNCING  
READY  
ONLINE  
The rectifier and inverter turn on. The inverter continues to ramp up to full  
voltage.  
8. Close the battery breakers for each UPM any time after INVERTER SYNCING or  
CLOSE BATTERY appears on the display.  
Once the inverter reaches full voltage, and the battery breaker is closed, each UPM  
output contactor K3 closes and each static switch turns off. Power is now supplied  
to the critical load in Normal mode. It takes approximately 1 minute for the UPMs  
to achieve Normal mode.  
9. The UPMs are now operating in Normal mode and the NORMAL status indicator  
on each UPM is illuminated.  
®
10-8  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Operating Instructions  
10.2.2 Starting the Parallel System in Bypass Mode  
If the inverter output of the UPMs is not available and the critical load needs to be  
energized, perform the following procedure:  
C A U T I O N  
In Bypass mode, the critical load is not protected from commercial power interruptions and  
abnormalities.  
1. Close all UPM input feeder circuit breakers.  
2. If the UPMs are dual feed, close all UPM Bypass input feeder circuit breakers.  
3. Observe all UPM control panel displays becoming active, indicating logic power.  
4. Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar of any UPM. The System  
Controls screen appears on each UPM.  
5. On the System Controls screen of each UPM, the power module (PM) status  
should indicate SHUTDOWN.  
6. Press the BYPASS pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar of any UPM.  
The critical load is immediately supplied by the bypass source, in Bypass mode.  
7. The UPMs are now operating in Bypass mode and the BYPASS status indicator on  
each UPM is illuminated.  
®
10-9  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Operating Instructions  
10.2.3 Transfer Parallel System from Normal to Bypass Mode  
To transfer the critical load to Bypass mode, perform the following procedure:  
C A U T I O N  
In Bypass mode, the critical load is not protected from commercial power interruptions and  
abnormalities.  
1. Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar on any UPM. The System  
Controls screen appears.  
2. Press the BYPASS pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar of any UPM.  
The UPMs transfer to Bypass mode and the critical load is immediately supplied by  
the bypass source. If the bypass source is not available, the power processor  
remains on and an alarm sounds.  
3. The UPMs are now operating in Bypass mode and the BYPASS status indicator on  
each UPM is illuminated.  
The power module (PM) status indicates READY on each UPM. The system is  
now on bypass and the UPM power processors remain on.  
W A R N I N G  
Power is present inside the UPM cabinets.  
10.2.4 Transfer Parallel System from Bypass to Normal Mode  
To transfer the critical load to Normal mode, perform the following procedure:  
1. Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar on any UPM. The System  
Control screen appears.  
2. Press the NORMAL pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar of any UPM.  
The UPMs transfer to Normal mode. If the power processor is not available, the  
system remains on bypass and an alarm sounds.  
3. The UPMs are now operating in Normal mode, and the NORMAL status indicator  
on each UPM is illuminated.  
The power module (PM) status indicates ONLINE on each UPM.  
®
10-10  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Operating Instructions  
10.2.5 Single UPM Shutdown  
To shut down a single UPM, perform the following procedure:  
NOTE The UPM can be shut down only if remaining UPMs can support the critical  
load without being overloaded.  
1. Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar on the UPM to be shut  
down. The System Controls screen appears.  
2. Press the pushbutton to display System Controls Screen 2.  
3. Press the PM OFF pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar.  
The power module (PM) status indicates SHUTDOWN. The input and output  
contactors open, the battery breaker or disconnect is tripped, and the power  
module is turned off.  
4. Open the input and bypass (if dual feed) feeder circuit breakers supplying the  
shutdown UPM.  
NOTE The monitor screen continues to be active until the UPM is isolated from the  
critical bus.  
W A R N I N G  
Power is present inside the shutdown UPM cabinet due to connection to the critical bus, until  
the UPM output breaker is opened.  
5. If it is necessary to isolate the UPM from the critical bus, open the module output  
breaker on the tie cabinet or distribution panel.  
10.2.6 Restarting a Single UPM  
To restart a single UPM, perform the following procedure:  
1. If the UPM was isolated from the critical bus, close the module output breaker on  
the tie cabinet or distribution panel.  
2. Observe the UPM control panel display becoming active, indicating logic power.  
UPM logic is being powered from the critical bus.  
3. Close the UPM input feeder circuit breaker.  
4. If the UPM is dual feed, close the UPM Bypass input feeder circuit breaker.  
5. Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar of the UPM. The System  
Controls screen appears.  
6. On the System Controls screen, the power module (PM) status should indicate  
SHUTDOWN.  
®
10-11  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Operating Instructions  
7. Press the NORMAL pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar of the UPM.  
8. Observe the following messages appear sequentially on the power module (PM)  
status line of the UPM:  
DC STARTING  
INVERTER STARTING  
INVERTER SYNCING  
READY  
ONLINE  
The rectifier and inverter turn on. When the inverter reaches full voltage, the UPM  
synchronizes with the output and closes output contactor K3. The UPM is online  
and in Normal mode with the NORMAL status indicator illuminated and in parallel  
with the other system UPMs.  
9. Close battery breakers for the UPM any time after INVERTER SYNCING or CLOSE  
BATTERY appears on the display.  
10.2.7 Parallel System and Critical Load Shutdown  
To perform maintenance or service on the critical load, shut down power to the load by  
performing the following procedure:  
C A U T I O N  
Using the following procedure removes all output from the critical load. You should use this  
procedure only when you need to de-energize both the parallel system and the critical load.  
1. Turn off all equipment that is being powered by the parallel system.  
2. Press the CONTROLS pushbutton on the main menu bar on any UPM. The System  
Controls screen appears.  
3. Press the BYPASS pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar of any UPM.  
The UPMs transfer to Bypass mode.  
4. Press the pushbutton to display System Controls Screen 2.  
5. Press the PM OFF pushbutton on the System Controls menu bar.  
The power module (PM) status indicates SHUTDOWN. The input and output  
contactors open, the battery breaker or disconnect is tripped, and the power  
module is turned off. The bypass source supplies the critical load.  
6. Repeat Steps 2, 4, and 5 for each UPM, except the last UPM  
®
10-12  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Operating Instructions  
7. To shut down the last UPM, press the REPO pushbutton switch. See “Using the  
Parallel System Remote Emergency Power-off Switch” in paragraph 10.2.9.  
The input, output, and bypass backfeed contactors open, the battery breaker or  
disconnect is tripped, and the power module is turned off immediately, without  
asking for verification.  
8. Open all UPM input and bypass (if dual feed) feeder circuit breakers.  
The parallel system and critical load is now de-energized.  
9. To restart the parallel system after using the REPO pushbutton, reset the REPO  
switch and then follow the procedure in paragraph 10.2.1 or 10.2.2.  
10.2.8 Using the UPS LOAD OFF Pushbutton  
NOTE The UPM LOAD OFF pushbutton controls only the UPM on which Load Off was  
activated and only interrupts the ability of that module to deliver power to the critical  
bus. The redundant modules continue to support the critical load. The UPM can be shut  
down only if the remaining UPMs can support the critical load without being  
overloaded. To remove all power from the critical load, use the REPO pushbutton.  
A UPS Load Off is initiated by the LOAD OFF pushbutton from the main menu bar or the  
System Controls menu bar. The UPS LOAD OFF pushbutton de-energizes the critical load  
and powers down the UPS.  
The UPS (including Bypass) remains off until restarted.  
To use the LOAD OFF pushbutton:  
1. Press the LOAD OFF pushbutton.  
The Load Off screen appears, providing a choice to proceed or abort the  
shutdown.  
C A U T I O N  
All power to the critical load is lost when the LOAD OFF is selected in the following step. You  
should use this feature only when you want to de-energize the critical load.  
2. To shut down the UPS, press LOAD OFF from the Load Off menu bar, and hold for  
three seconds. To abort the shutdown, press CANCEL.  
When LOAD OFF is selected and held for three seconds, the input, output, and  
bypass backfeed contactors open, the battery breaker or disconnect is tripped,  
and the power module is turned off.  
®
10-13  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UPS Operating Instructions  
C A U T I O N  
Do not attempt to restart the system after Load Off until the cause of the shutdown has been  
identified and cleared.  
3. To restart the UPS after pressing the LOAD OFF pushbutton, follow the procedure  
in paragraph 10.2.1 or 10.2.2.  
10.2.9 Using the Parallel System Remote Emergency Power-off Switch  
A parallel system emergency power-off is initiated by the REPO pushbutton switch. In an  
emergency, you can use this switch to control the UPM outputs. The REPO switch  
de-energizes the critical load and powers down the UPMs immediately, without asking for  
verification.  
The UPMs, including Bypass, remain off until restarted.  
C A U T I O N  
All power to the critical load is lost when the REPO switch is activated in the following step.  
You should use this feature only when you want to de-energize the critical load.  
NOTE The following instructions are for the Powerware-supplied REPO switch. If a  
customer-supplied REPO switch is used, it may not activate in the same manner; refer  
to the operating instructions provided with the switch.  
To use the REPO switch:  
1. Press the REPO pushbutton switch.  
The input, output, and bypass backfeed contactors open, the battery breaker or  
disconnect is tripped, and the power module is turned off immediately, without  
asking for verification.  
C A U T I O N  
Do not attempt to restart the system after Load Off until the cause of the shutdown has been  
identified and cleared.  
2. To restart the UPMs after using the REPO pushbutton, reset the REPO switch and  
then follow the procedure in paragraph 10.2.1 or 10.2.2.  
®
10-14  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 11 Using Features and Options  
The many standard features of your UPS system provide consistent, economical, and  
dependable power protection. In addition, you can add available options to enhance the  
performance of your system. This chapter provides descriptions of some of the features  
and options introduced earlier in this manual. For location of the customer interface panel  
and terminals and for terminal wiring information, see:  
Ī Drawing 164201604-6 on page A-27  
Ī Drawing 164201604-8 starting on page A-33  
11.1 Building Alarm Monitoring  
This standard feature lets you connect the UPS to your building alarms, such as smoke  
detectors or overtemperature alarms. The customer interface terminals for external  
connections are located inside the UPS. You should use twisted-pair wires for each alarm  
input and common.  
The building alarms can be programmed to display the alarm functional name.  
11.2 General Purpose Relay Contact  
One general purpose relay contact is provided as a standard feature on the UPS. The alarm  
contact is located inside the UPS on the customer interface terminal board.  
You can use a normally-closed or normally-open contact. If the state of the contact  
changes from the state you specify as normal, a signal is issued. You can connect this  
contact to equipment at your facility (such as a light or an alarm bell) to let you know  
when an alarm is active on the UPS. This feature is useful if the UPS is located in a remote  
area where the UPS horn may not be heard immediately.  
C A U T I O N  
Contacts should not be operated in excess of 120 Vac @ 5A maximum.  
®
11-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Features and Options  
11.3 Optional Remote Monitor Panel II  
As an option, a Remote Monitor Panel II (RMP II) can be installed to monitor the operation  
of the UPS system from virtually any location within the facility, up to 152.4m (500 ft) from  
the UPS. The RMP II contains backlit status indicators and a local horn. The RMP II can be  
flush-mounted or surface-mounted on a desktop, or secured to a wall. Figure 11-1 shows  
an RMP II.  
Figure 11-1. Remote Monitor Panel II  
®
11-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Features and Options  
The RMP II contains a local horn and the backlit status indicators listed in Table 11-1.  
Table 11-1. RMP II Status Indicators  
SYSTEM NORMAL  
The UPS is energized (either with utility power or battery  
backup) and is supplying conditioned power to the  
critical load.  
NO REDUNDANCY  
This indicator applies only to parallel systems when one  
cabinet is not functioning.  
ON GENERATOR  
The UPS input and bypass are being supplied by the power  
from the generator instead of from the utility power.  
ON BYPASS  
The bypass source is supplying the critical load. Usually  
this means that the UPS is not energized. The load is not  
protected in Bypass mode, and a horn sounds after  
30 seconds.  
UPS ALARM  
The UPS system is issuing an alarm. Conditions that  
affect the current UPS mode are indicated by the  
indicators and horn on the UPS.  
ON BATTERY  
The UPS battery backup is supplying the critical load.  
The utility power is either interrupted or out of  
specification. The SYSTEM NORMAL indicator is also  
illuminated.  
BYPASS UNAVAILABLE  
The UPS system is in Normal mode, but a bypass source  
is not within specification. A horn sounds after  
30 seconds.  
SHUTDOWN IMMINENT  
The UPS is preparing to shut down because the UPS is in  
Battery mode and the DC voltage is approaching its low  
limit. This indicator is accompanied by a horn.  
®
11-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Features and Options  
11.4 Relay Interface Module II  
An optional RIM II uses relay contact closures to indicate the operating status and alarm  
condition of the UPS system. The RIM II can be flush-mounted or surface-mounted on a  
desktop, or secured to a wall. Figure 11-2 shows the RIM II with its four 15-pin connectors  
labeled J1 through J4.  
Figure 11-2. Relay Interface Module II  
The RIM II can provide the status and alarm signals shown in Table 11-2.  
Table 11-2. Customer Interface Connectors  
Status  
J1 through J4  
Description  
Pins 1 and 12 Contacts are closed when the UPS is operating in  
Normal mode or ready to supply the load.  
UPS AVAILABLE  
Pins 3 and 13 Contacts are open when the UPS is offline.  
Contacts are closed when the UPS is operating in  
Normal mode.  
UPS OFFLINE  
Pins 5 and 14 Contacts are closed when approximately two minutes of  
battery time is remaining, before the critical load is lost.  
BATTERY WEAK  
UTILITY FAILURE  
Pins 6 and 15 Contacts are closed when Utility Failure is detected.  
®
11-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Features and Options  
11.5 Supervisory Contact Module II  
An optional SCM II establishes an interface between the UPS system and the customer’s  
monitor. This interface allows the customer to monitor operational status of the UPS  
system equipment. The SCM II can be flush-mounted or surface-mounted on a desktop, or  
secured to a wall. Figure 11-3 shows the SCM II.  
Figure 11-3. Supervisory Contact Module II  
The SCM II provides signals for the indications shown in Table 11-3.  
Table 11-3. SCM II Status Indicators and Connections  
TB-2 Connections  
Indication  
SYSTEM NORMAL  
TB2-1 through TB2-3  
TB2-4 through TB2-6  
TB2-7 through TB2-9  
NO REDUNDANCY  
ON GENERATOR  
BYPASS NOT AVAILABLE  
ON BATTERY  
TB2-10 through TB2-12  
TB2-13 through TB2-15  
TB2-16 through TB2-18  
TB2-19 through TB2-21  
TB2-22 through TB2-24  
UPS ALARM  
ON BYPASS  
SHUTDOWN IMMINENT  
®
11-5  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Features and Options  
This page intentionally left blank.  
®
11-6  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 12 Responding to System Events  
12.1 General  
When the UPS system is running in Normal mode, it continually monitors itself and the  
incoming utility power. In Battery or Bypass modes, the UPS may issue alarms to let you  
know exactly what event caused the change from Normal mode. System events on the UPS  
can be indicated by horns, lights, messages, or all three.  
Select Events from the menu bar on the Main Menu screen to look at the Active System  
Events screen. This screen shows any currently active alarms, notices, or commands. For  
more information on using the Events screen, see paragraph 9.2.2, “Event Screens.”  
12.2 System Event Horns  
The system event horn beeps to alert an operator that an event needing attention is taking  
place. Horn 1 cycles at a one-second rate.  
12.3 System Event Indicators  
The status indicators on the UPS control panel work in conjunction with the event horn to  
let you know when the UPS system is operating in any mode other than Normal. Only the  
Normal indicator is visible during normal UPS system operation. The other indicators  
illuminate to indicate alarms or events. When an alarm occurs, you should first check these  
indicators to see what type of event has taken place. For descriptions of the status  
indicators, see paragraph 9.5, “Reading the Status Indicators.”  
12.4 System Event Messages  
When a system event occurs, a message appears on the LCD in the UPS status area. This  
message is also written to the Active Events log and may be added to the Events History  
log. The messages are divided into four categories: alarms, notices, status, and commands.  
The following tables contain the events displayed on the Events screen of the control  
panel.  
®
12-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Responding to System Events  
ALARMS  
Horn  
Phone  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1
Relay  
1
Log*  
Message  
Indication  
Battery Totally Discharged  
Battery Totally Discharged OK  
Building Alarm 1  
1
Off  
1
HA Shutdown Imminent  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
1
1
Building Alarm 1 OK  
Building Alarm 2  
Off  
1
1
1
Building Alarm 2 OK  
Check Bypass  
Off  
1
1
1
Check Bypass OK  
Off  
1
No  
No  
No  
1
1
Check Bypass Switchgear  
Check Bypass Switchgear OK  
Check Charger  
1
Off  
1
1
1
Check Charger OK  
Off  
1
No  
No  
No  
1
1
Check Fan  
1
Check Fan OK  
Off  
1
1
Check Input Switchgear  
Check Input Switchgear OK  
Check Inv Temperature Sensor  
Check Inv Temperature Sensor OK  
Check Inverter  
1
Off  
1
No  
No  
No  
1
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
Check Logic Power Supply  
Check Logic Power Supply OK  
Check Output Switchgear  
Check Output Switchgear OK  
Check Power Supply  
Check Power Supply OK  
Check Precharge  
1
No  
No  
No  
No  
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
Off  
1
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1
1
1
Check Precharge OK  
Check Rect Temperature Sensor  
Check Rect Temperature Sensor OK  
Check Rectifier  
Off  
1
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
Check Static Switch  
1
1
1
Check Static Switch OK  
Close Battery Switchgear  
Close Battery Switchgear OK  
Off  
1
No  
1
1
1
Off  
No  
1
*Log codes indicate where the UPS records the event: H = History log; HA = History and Active logs; and  
A = Active log only.  
®
12-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Responding to System Events  
ALARMS  
Horn  
Phone  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1
Relay  
1
Log*  
Message  
Indication  
Configuration Error  
1
Off  
1
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Service Required  
HA Service Required  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
Configuration Error OK  
External Comm Failure  
External Comm Failure OK  
Internal Comm Failure  
Internal Comm Failure OK  
Invalid Board ID  
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
Invalid Board ID OK  
Off  
1
1
Inverter L1 Current Limit  
Inverter L2 Current Limit  
Inverter L3 Current Limit  
Inverter Output Failure  
Inverter Output Failure OK  
Inverter Overtemperature  
Inverter Overtemperature OK  
Inverter Overtemperature Trip  
Inverter Overtemperature Trip OK  
L1 Overload  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Off  
1
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
L1 Overload OK  
Off  
1
1
L1 Overload (Extreme Level)  
L1 Overload (Extreme Level) OK  
L1 Overload (High Level)  
L1 Overload (High Level) OK  
L2 Overload  
1
Off  
1
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
L2 Overload OK  
Off  
1
1
L2 Overload (Extreme Level)  
L2 Overload (Extreme Level) OK  
L2 Overload (High Level)  
L2 Overload (High Level) OK  
L3 Overload  
1
Off  
1
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
L3 Overload OK  
Off  
1
1
L3 Overload (Extreme Level)  
L3 Overload (Extreme Level) OK  
1
Off  
1
*Log codes indicate where the UPS records the event: H = History log; HA = History and Active logs; and  
A = Active log only.  
®
12-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Responding to System Events  
ALARMS  
Horn  
Phone  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1
Relay  
1
Log*  
Message  
Indication  
L3 Overload (High Level)  
L3 Overload (High Level) OK  
Low Battery Shutdown  
Low Battery Shutdown OK  
Not Enough UPMs  
1
Off  
1
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Service Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA User Action Required  
HA Condition Cleared  
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
Not Enough UPMs OK  
Output Overload  
Off  
1
1
1
Output Overload OK  
Off  
1
1
Output Watts Overload  
Output Watts Overload OK  
Parallel System Overload  
Parallel System Overload OK  
Rect Overtemperature Trip  
Rect Overtemperature Trip OK  
Rectifier Overtemperature  
Rectifier Overtemperature OK  
Remote Emergency Power-off  
Remote Emergency Power-off OK  
Selective Trip  
1
Off  
1
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
Selective Trip OK  
Off  
1
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1
Shutdown Imminent  
1
Shutdown Imminent OK  
Software Incompatibility  
Software Incompatibility OK  
Utility Out Of Limits  
Off  
1
1
1
Off  
1
1
1
Utility Out Of Limits OK  
Off  
1
*Log codes indicate where the UPS records the event: H = History log; HA = History and Active logs; and  
A = Active log only.  
®
12-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Responding to System Events  
NOTICES  
Horn  
1
Phone  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1
Relay Log*  
Indication  
Message  
Automatic Shutdown Pending  
Automatic Shutdown Pending OK  
Automatic Startup Pending  
Battery Current Limit  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
A
A
A
Information Only  
Condition Cleared  
Information Only  
OFF  
1
1
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
Battery Current Limit OK  
Battery Voltage High  
Off  
1
Battery Voltage High OK  
Battery Voltage Low  
Off  
1
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1
Battery Voltage Low OK  
Bypass AC Over Voltage  
Bypass AC Over Voltage OK  
Bypass AC Under Voltage  
Bypass AC Under Voltage OK  
Bypass Phase Rotation  
Off  
1
Off  
1
Off  
1
Bypass Phase Rotation OK  
Bypass Source Out of Tolerance  
Bypass Source Out of Tolerance OK  
Bypass Under or Over Frequency  
Bypass Under or Over Frequency OK  
Charger Off Command  
Charger On Command  
Charger Over Voltage or Current  
Charger Tripped  
Off  
1
A
Condition Cleared  
HA Investigate UPS  
Off  
1
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Information Only  
HA Information Only  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
Off  
1
1
1
1
Charger Tripped OK  
Off  
1
Check Battery  
Check Battery OK  
Off  
1
Check Modem  
Check Modem OK  
Off  
1
DC Link Over Voltage  
DC Link Over Voltage OK  
DC Link Under Voltage  
DC Link Under Voltage OK  
Emergency Transfer To Bypass  
Emergency Transfer To Bypass OK  
Off  
1
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
A
Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
Off  
1
Off  
A
Condition Cleared  
*Log codes indicate where the UPS records the event: H = History log; HA = History and Active logs; and  
A = Active log only.  
®
12-5  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Responding to System Events  
NOTICES  
Horn  
1
Phone  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1
Relay Log*  
Indication  
Message  
Input AC Over Voltage  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
Input AC Over Voltage OK  
Input AC Under Voltage  
Off  
1
Input AC Under Voltage OK  
Input Phase Rotation  
Off  
1
Input Phase Rotation OK  
Input Under or Over Frequency  
Input Under or Over Frequency OK  
Inv Under or Over Frequency  
Inv Under or Over Frequency OK  
Inverter AC Over Voltage  
Inverter AC Over Voltage OK  
Inverter AC Under Voltage  
Inverter AC Under Voltage OK  
Inverter Off Command  
Off  
1
Off  
1
Off  
1
Off  
1
Off  
1
A
Information Only  
Inverter On Command  
1
HA Information Only  
HA Information Only  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Investigate UPS  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Information Only  
HA Information Only  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Information Only  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
Inverter Output Overcurrent  
Inverter Phase Rotation  
1
1
Inverter Phase Rotation OK  
Load Dumped (Load Power Off)  
Load Dumped (Load Power Off) OK  
Load Off Command Executed  
Load Power On Command  
Load Power On Command Received  
Loss of Redundancy  
Off  
1
Off  
1
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1
1
1
Loss of Redundancy OK  
Off  
1
Maintenance Bypass Mode  
Modem Call Completion Failed  
Neutral Current Limit  
1
1
Neutral Current Limit OK  
Non-Volatile Memory Failure  
Non-Volatile Memory Failure OK  
Output AC Over Voltage  
Output AC Over Voltage OK  
Off  
1
A
A
Information Only  
Condition Cleared  
Off  
1
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
Off  
*Log codes indicate where the UPS records the event: H = History log; HA = History and Active logs; and  
A = Active log only.  
®
12-6  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Responding to System Events  
NOTICES  
Horn  
1
Phone  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Relay Log*  
Indication  
Message  
Output AC Under Voltage  
Output AC Under Voltage OK  
Output Under or Over Frequency  
Output Under or Over Frequency OK  
Rectifier Current Over 125%  
Rectifier Input Over Current  
UPS Module Off  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
HA Information Only  
HA Condition Cleared  
Off  
1
Off  
1
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
Information Only  
Information Only  
Information Only  
Condition Cleared  
Investigate UPS  
1
1
UPS Module Off OK  
Off  
1
UPS on Battery  
UPS on Battery OK  
Off  
1
Condition Cleared  
Investigate UPS  
UPS on Bypass  
UPS on Bypass OK  
Off  
1
Condition Cleared  
Information Only  
Condition Cleared  
UPS on Generator  
UPS on Generator OK  
Off  
*Log codes indicate where the UPS records the event: H = History log; HA = History and Active logs; and  
A = Active log only.  
®
12-7  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Responding to System Events  
STATUS  
Horn  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Phone  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Relay Log*  
Message  
Indication  
User Status  
User Status  
User Status  
User Status  
User Status  
User Status  
Battery Switchgear Closed  
Battery Switchgear Open  
Bypass Switchgear Closed  
Bypass Switchgear Open  
Charger Status Off  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1
H
H
H
H
H
H
Charger Status On  
Check Heatsink Temp Sensor  
Check Heatsink Temp Sensor OK  
Control Power Status Off  
Control Power Status On  
Heatsink Overtemperature  
Heatsink Overtemperature OK  
Incoming Modem Call Started  
Inverter Status Off  
No Service Status  
No User Status  
No User Status  
No User Status  
No Service Status  
No User Status  
H
User Status  
No User Status  
No User Status  
Inverter Status On  
Modem Call Completed Successfully  
Modem Connection Established  
Outgoing Modem Call Started  
Output Switchgear Open  
Output Switchgear Open OK  
Rectifier Phase L1 Current Limit  
Rectifier Phase L2 Current Limit  
Rectifier Phase L3 Current Limit  
Rectifier Status Off  
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
User Status  
User Status  
User Status  
User Status  
User Status  
Service Status  
Service Status  
Service Status  
User Status  
User Status  
Rectifier Status On  
Rectifier Switchgear Closed  
Rectifier Switchgear Open  
Rectifier Tripped  
No User Status  
No User Status  
H
User Status  
System Alarm Active  
No User Status  
No User Status  
System Notice Active  
No  
No  
UPS Normal  
H
User Status  
*Log codes indicate where the UPS records the event: H = History log; HA = History and Active logs; and  
A = Active log only.  
®
12-8  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Responding to System Events  
COMMAND  
Horn  
Yes  
Phone  
Relay Log*  
Indication  
Message  
Load Off Command Received  
To Normal Mode Command  
To Bypass Command  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
H
H
H
Information Only  
Information Only  
Information Only  
No  
No  
*Log codes indicate where the UPS records the event: H = History log; HA = History and Active logs; and  
A = Active log only.  
®
12-9  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Responding to System Events  
This page intentionally left blank.  
®
12-10  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 13 Communication  
This chapter describes the communication features of the Powerware 9390 100–160 kVA  
UPS and provides information about connecting hardware and using Terminal mode.  
13.1 X-Slot Cards  
The Powerware 9390 UPS has a standard, factory-installed X-Slot communication bay with  
two slots. An optional second bay is available, providing two additional slots. See Drawing  
164201604-8 starting on page A-33 for bay locations. The UPS is compatible with the  
following X-Slot cards (see Figure 13-1):  
Ī Modbus Card - provides direct integration of UPS information (meters and status) to a  
Building Management System (BMS) using the Modbus RTU protocol.  
Ī ConnectUPS-X Web/SNMP Card - provides remote monitoring through a Web browser  
interface, e-mail, and a network management system using SNMP; connects to a  
twisted-pair Ethernet (10/100BaseT) network. It has a built-in switching hub that allows  
three additional network devices to be connected to the network without the  
requirement of additional network drops. This card is provided as standard equipment  
with the UPS.  
NOTE The Modem Card cannot be installed in X-Slot 2. If the UPS has only two  
X-Slots, move the ConnectUPS-X Web/SNMP Card to X-Slot 2 and install the Modem  
Card in X-Slot 1.  
Ī Modem Card - provides “out-of-band” remote notification and monitoring using modem  
communication directly to cell phones and pagers.  
Ī Relay Interface Card (AS/400) - has isolated dry contact (Form-C) relay outputs for UPS  
status: Utility failure, Low battery, UPS alarm/OK, or On bypass when interfacing with  
®
IBM AS/400 computers, other relay connected computers, and industrial applications.  
Ī Industrial Relay Card (IRC) - indicates the operating status of the UPS system using the  
customer’s monitoring equipment. The IRC uses four isolated normally-open or  
normally-closed dry relay contacts to indicate the UPS status. Normal, Bypass, Battery,  
and Alarm modes can be monitored.  
Ī Powerware Hot Sync Computer Area Network (CAN) Bridge Card - provides connectivity  
for operational mode control and metering of a parallel system at any UPM in the  
system. In addition, this card can be used to connect optional system monitoring  
devices, such as a Remote Monitor Panel II, a Relay Interface Module II, or a Supervisory  
Contact Module II to the UPS.  
®
13-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Communication  
LAN and telephone drops for use with X-Slot connectivity cards must be provided by  
facility planners or the customer.  
For installation and setup of an X-Slot card, please contact Powerware (see page 1-6). Refer  
to the manual supplied with the X-Slot card for user instructions.  
ConnectUPS-X Web/SNMP Card  
Modem Card  
Powerware Hot Sync  
CAN Bridge Card  
Modbus Card  
Relay Interface Card  
Industrial Relay Card  
Figure 13-1. Optional X-Slot Cards  
13.2 LanSafe Power Management Software  
Each Powerware 9390 UPS ships with LanSafe Power Management Software. To begin  
installing LanSafe software, see the instructions accompanying the Powerware Software  
Suite CD.  
LanSafe software uses an RS-232 serial link to communicate with the UPS. The software  
provides up-to-date graphics of UPS power and system data and power flow, a complete  
record of critical power events, and notification of important UPS or power information.  
With custom views for monitoring status and metering information, various user groups  
can select the most useful view for their specific needs.  
13.3 Remote Notification  
For connection and setup of a modem, or to enable Remote Notify and Call Home features  
within the UPS, please contact Powerware (see page 1-6).  
Remote Notification provides the UPS with the capability to use a standard off-the-shelf PC  
modem as a telephone interface. The features provided by this option are:  
Ī Call a remote terminal or pager based on programmable events and alarms  
Ī Four separate, programmable notification groups (phone numbers)  
Ī Automatic answering (user-configurable) for access to the Terminal mode of the UPS  
Ī Remote and local ability to clear Call Out alarms and events  
Ī Error detection and correction for misconfigured and disconnected modems.  
Remote Notification provides the user with the option of receiving alarms and notices at a  
remote location. Using the Terminal mode, the user calls the UPS to perform basic  
monitoring. In the event of a UPS alarm or notice, the user is notified at the remote  
location. The UPS calls through the modem to the user’s computer or pager and leaves a  
message.  
®
13-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Communication  
Remote Notification is an extension of the Terminal mode with the additional support  
algorithms necessary to control an external modem. Connection to the UPS is made when  
a user calls the UPS on the phone. The user has exactly the same capabilities as if using a  
terminal connected directly to an RS-232 port.  
Remote Notification differs from the basic Terminal mode with the addition the following  
functions:  
Ī Call Answer  
The Call Answer function allows the user to call into the UPS from a remote location  
and enter Terminal mode.  
Ī Call Out  
The Call Out function allows the UPS to be configured to call either a remote computer  
or numeric paging service over the phone line. Call Out allows the UPS to call a remote  
computer and leave a one-line descriptive message of the alarm or notice condition.  
Numeric paging support allows the UPS to call a paging service and send numeric  
messages.  
Ī Housekeeping  
The Housekeeping function maintains the link between the UPS and modem.  
13.4 Terminal Mode  
NOTE The brackets ([ ]) in the following bullets indicate standard keyboard characters.  
To use a key combination, hold down the Escape key and press the indicated letter key.  
In Terminal mode, the user can request the following:  
Ī [ESC] [V] displays the UPS control panel.  
Ī [ESC] [H] displays the Event History.  
Ī [ESC] [N] displays the Node Bits Setup.  
Ī [ESC] [L] displays any new event.  
Ī [ESC] [B] displays the Battery Log.  
13.4.1 Display UPS Control Panel  
When this function is invoked, a facsimile of the UPS control panel is displayed on the  
terminal screen. All controls are functional and can control the UPS remotely. The only  
exception is the Load Off control which requires the operator to press and hold the local  
control for two seconds to shut down the UPS.  
To remotely control the UPS or view UPS information, use the escape key legend to  
control the function normally controlled by the control panel softkeys. See Chapter 9,  
“Using the Control Panel,” for instructions on navigating the control panel.  
®
13-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Communication  
13.4.2 Event History Log  
This key sequence prints the entire Event History Log of the UPS at the time the data is  
requested. The printout begins with the oldest alarm entry in the queue and ends with the  
most recent. Any alarms that occur while the Event History Log is printing are included in  
chronological order.  
The Event History Log lists up to 500 system events in chronological order with the most  
recent event listed last. Figure 13-2 shows a sample Event History Log printout.  
In this mode, system events are continually logged through the serial port to the device  
connected to the port.  
The printed log entries contain a time and date stamp and the alarm text message.  
Terminal mode uses this format for printing alarm entries:  
MM DD YYYY  
HH:MM:SS.hh  
KYWD  
MESSAGE  
<CR> <LF>  
Where:  
MM  
Equals:  
Month (2 digits)  
Day (2 digits)  
DD  
YYYY  
HH  
Year (4 digits)  
Hour (2 digits)  
Minute (2 digits)  
Second (2 digits)  
MM  
SS  
hh  
Hundredths of Second (3 digits)  
KYWD  
MESSAGE  
<CR>  
<LF>  
Keyword (ALARM, NOTICE, COMMAND, or STATUS)  
System Diagnostic Information  
Carriage Return Character (ASCII 13)  
Line Feed (ASCII 10)  
An alarm message is prefixed by the word “CLEAR” whenever an alarm is entered into the  
Event History Log with a cleared status.  
If a port is operating in Terminal mode and is connected to a computer, you can press  
[Esc] [H] to print the entire log with a firmware version header.  
®
13-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Communication  
03/11/2004 14:13:03.000 STATUS: CSB Power Supply On  
03/11/2004 14:13:03.043 NOTICE: Inverter Initializing  
03/11/2004 14:13:05.721 STATUS: UPS Power Supply OK  
03/11/2004 14:13:05.728 NOTICE: Input Under Voltage  
03/11/2004 14:13:05.729 NOTICE: Output Under Voltage  
03/11/2004 14:13:05.729 NOTICE: Bypass Under Voltage  
03/11/2004 14:13:05.749 ALARM: Rectifier Under Voltage  
03/11/2004 14:13:10.459 ALARM: Battery Under Voltage  
03/11/2004 14:13:12.954 NOTICE: Battery Voltage Low  
03/11/2004 14:13:13.165 NOTICE: Battery Not Present  
03/11/2004 14:13:34.710 STATUS: PPU Shutdown  
03/11/2004 14:13:57.773 NOTICE: Check Modem  
03/11/2004 14:14:33.520 ALARM: Inverter Tripped  
03/11/2004 14:14:33.520 ALARM: Check Inverter  
03/11/2004 14:27:09.000 STATUS: CSB Power Supply On  
03/11/2004 14:27:09.043 NOTICE: Inverter Initializing  
03/11/2004 14:27:11.725 STATUS: UPS Power Supply OK  
03/11/2004 14:27:11.733 NOTICE: Input Under Voltage  
03/11/2004 14:27:11.733 NOTICE: Output Under Voltage  
03/11/2004 14:27:11.733 NOTICE: Bypass Under Voltage  
03/11/2004 14:27:11.754 ALARM: Rectifier Under Voltage  
03/11/2004 14:27:16.464 ALARM: Battery Under Voltage  
03/11/2004 14:27:18.954 NOTICE: Battery Voltage Low  
03/11/2004 14:27:19.169 NOTICE: Battery Not Present  
03/11/2004 14:27:40.714 STATUS: PPU Shutdown  
03/11/2004 14:28:04.023 NOTICE: Check Modem  
03/12/2004 14:15:09.000 STATUS: CSB Power Supply On  
03/12/2004 14:15:09.043 NOTICE: Inverter Initializing  
03/12/2004 14:15:11.725 STATUS: UPS Power Supply OK  
03/12/2004 14:15:11.733 NOTICE: Input Under Voltage  
03/12/2004 14:15:11.733 NOTICE: Output Under Voltage  
03/12/2004 14:15:11.754 ALARM: Rectifier Under Voltage  
03/12/2004 14:15:11.833 NOTICE: Maintenance Bypass On  
03/12/2004 14:15:16.463 ALARM: Battery Under Voltage  
03/12/2004 14:15:18.954 NOTICE: Battery Voltage Low  
03/12/2004 14:15:19.169 NOTICE: Battery Not Present  
03/12/2004 14:15:40.714 STATUS: PPU Shutdown  
03/12/2004 14:16:04.023 NOTICE: Check Modem  
03/12/2004 14:16:22.925 CMD:  
Bypass Mode Command  
03/12/2004 14:16:23.443 STATUS: K5 (Backfeed) Closed  
03/12/2004 14:16:23.586 STATUS: On Bypass  
03/12/2004 14:16:24.860 NOTICE: Output Under Voltage OK  
03/12/2004 14:17:20.900 NOTICE: Input Under Voltage OK  
03/12/2004 14:17:23.606 ALARM: Rectifier Under Voltage OK  
03/12/2004 14:17:25.557 ALARM: Battery Under Voltage OK  
03/12/2004 14:19:01.899 CMD:  
PPU On Command  
03/12/2004 14:19:04.089 STATUS: K1 (Input) Closed  
Figure 13-2. Sample Event History Log  
®
13-5  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Communication  
This page intentionally left blank.  
®
13-6  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 14 Maintaining the UPS System  
The components inside the UPS cabinet are secured to a sturdy metal frame. All repairable  
parts and assemblies are located for easy removal, with very little disassembly. This design  
allows authorized service personnel to perform routine maintenance and servicing quickly.  
You must schedule periodic performance checks of your UPS system to keep it running  
properly. Regular routine checks of operation and system parameters enable your system  
to function efficiently for many trouble-free years.  
14.1 Important Safety Instructions  
Remember that your UPS system is designed to supply power EVEN WHEN  
DISCONNECTED FROM THE UTILITY POWER. The UPS module interiors are unsafe until  
the DC power source is disconnected and the electrolytic capacitors are discharged. After  
disconnecting the utility power and the DC power, authorized service personnel should  
wait at least five minutes for capacitor bleedoff before attempting internal access to the  
UPS module.  
W A R N I N G  
Ī Servicing and maintenance should be performed by qualified service personnel only.  
Ī LETHAL VOLTAGE PRESENT. This unit should not be operated with the cabinet doors open  
or protective panels removed. Do not make any assumptions about the electrical state of  
any cabinet in the UPS system.  
Since each battery string is an energy source in itself, opening the battery circuit breaker  
does not de-energize the voltage within the battery string. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO ACCESS  
ANY INTERNAL AREA OF THE BATTERY STRING YOURSELF. VOLTAGES ARE ALWAYS  
PRESENT IN THE BATTERY STRING. If you suspect that a battery string needs service, you  
should contact your Eaton service representative.  
If the string requires service, refer to the battery manufacturer’s operating manual for  
instructions on battery maintenance or contact your Eaton service representative.  
Observe these precautions when working on or around batteries:  
Ī Remove watches, rings, or other metal objects.  
Ī Use tools with insulated handles.  
Ī Wear rubber gloves and boots.  
Ī Do not lay tools or metal parts on top of batteries or battery cabinets.  
Ī Disconnect the charging source prior to connecting or disconnecting terminals.  
®
14-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintaining the UPS System  
Ī Determine if the battery is inadvertently grounded. If it is, remove the source of the  
ground. Contact with any part of a grounded battery can result in electrical shock. The  
likelihood of such shock is reduced if such grounds are removed during installation and  
maintenance.  
Ī When replacing batteries, use the same number of sealed, lead-acid batteries.  
Ī Proper disposal of batteries is required. Refer to your local codes for disposal  
requirements.  
W A R N I N G  
Ī HAZARDOUS WASTE. Do not incinerate or dispose of batteries indiscriminately. Observe  
local and national codes.  
Ī Do not dispose of battery or batteries in a fire. The battery may explode.  
Ī Do not open or mutilate the battery or batteries. Released electrolyte is harmful to the skin  
and eyes, and may be toxic.  
Ī A battery can cause electrical shock, burn from high short-circuit current, or fire. Observe  
proper precautions.  
A T T E N T I O N !  
Ī Une batterie peut prêsenter un risque de choc êlectrique, de brulure, ou d’incendie. Suivre  
les précautions qui s’imposent.  
Ī Pour le remplacement, utiliser le même nombre et modéle des batteries.  
Ī L’élimination des batteries est règlementée. Consulter les codes locaux à cet effet.  
14.2 Performing Preventive Maintenance  
The UPS system requires very little preventive maintenance. However, the system should be  
inspected periodically to verify that the units are operating normally and that the batteries  
are in good condition.  
14.2.1 DAILY Maintenance  
Perform the following steps daily:  
1. Check the area surrounding the UPS system. Ensure the area is not cluttered,  
allowing free access to the unit.  
2. Ensure the air intakes (vents on the front doors) and exhaust opening (on top of  
the UPS cabinet sections) are not blocked.  
®
14-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintaining the UPS System  
3. Ensure the operating environment is within the parameters specified in  
Chapter 15, “Product Specifications,” and Drawing 164201604-2 on page A-3.  
4. Ensure the UPS is in Normal mode (Normal status indicator is illuminated). If an  
alarm lamp is illuminated or the Normal status indicator is not illuminated, contact  
your Eaton service representative.  
14.2.2 MONTHLY Maintenance  
Perform the following steps monthly:  
1. Monitor system parameters as described in Chapter 9, “Using the Control Panel.”  
2. Check the air filters (located behind the front doors) and replace as necessary. The  
left filter size is 16×30×1and the right filter size is 12×30×1. To remove  
the filters:  
a. Open the front door latch and swing the doors open.  
b. Slide each filter up and remove from the cabinet.  
c. Slide the new filters into the brackets until seated on the bottom brackets.  
d. Close the doors and secure the latch.  
3. Record the check results and any corrective actions in a suitable log.  
14.2.3 ANNUAL Maintenance  
Annual preventive maintenance should be performed only by authorized service personnel  
familiar with maintenance and servicing of the UPS system. Contact your Eaton service  
representative for more information about service offerings.  
14.2.4 BATTERY Maintenance  
Contact your Eaton service representative for battery maintenance. Battery replacement  
and maintenance should be performed only by authorized service personnel.  
14.3 Maintenance Training  
A basic training course, available from Powerware, gives you a competent working  
knowledge of the UPS system operation and teaches you how to perform first level  
corrective maintenance. For more information about training and other services, contact  
the Eaton Help Desk for Powerware products (see page 1-6).  
®
14-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintaining the UPS System  
This page intentionally left blank.  
®
14-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 15 Product Specifications  
15.1 Model Numbers  
The UPS systems are housed in free-standing cabinets with safety shields behind the doors.  
The UPS systems are available in 50/60 Hz with various output power ratings.  
Models  
Powere Rating  
Frequency  
Powerware 9390-120/100  
Powerware 9390-120/120  
Powerware 9390-160/100  
Powerware 9390-160/120  
Powerware 9390-160/160  
100 kVA  
120 kVA  
100 kVA  
120 kVA  
160 kVA  
50/60 Hz  
50/60 Hz  
50/60 Hz  
50/60 Hz  
50/60 Hz  
The following sections detail the input, output, environmental, and battery specifications  
for the UPS.  
15.2 Single Module Specifications  
15.2.1 UPS System Input  
208 Vac for operation from 177 Vac to 229 Vac  
220 Vac for operation from 187 Vac to 242 Vac  
480 Vac for operation from 408 Vac to 528 Vac  
Operating Input Voltage  
(Nominal +10/–15%)  
¦5 Hz  
Operating Input  
Frequency Range  
See Appendix A, Table E through Table G.  
Operating Input Current  
Reduced for Generator  
Adjustable  
5% THD at full load  
Input Current Harmonic  
Content  
Minimum 0.99  
Power Factor  
Line Surges  
6 kV OC, 3 kA SC per ANSI 62.41 and IEC 801-4  
384 Vdc (208V/220V units only)  
432 Vdc  
480 Vdc  
Battery Voltage  
®
15-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Product Specifications  
15.2.2 UPS System Output  
100% rated current  
UPS Output Capacity  
¦1% (10% to 100% load)  
Output Voltage  
Regulation  
208 Vac nominal, adjustable from 202 Vac to 214 Vac  
220 Vac nominal, adjustable from 214 Vac to 226 Vac  
480 Vac nominal, adjustable from 466 Vac to 494 Vac  
Output Voltage  
Adjustment  
(Nominal +/–3%)  
1.5% max THD (linear load)  
5% max THD (nonlinear load)  
Output Voltage Harmonic  
Content  
See Appendix A, Table E through Table G.  
Output Current  
3% for 100% maximum load imbalance (linear load)  
3° for 100% maximum load imbalance (linear load)  
Output Voltage Balance  
Output Voltage Phase  
Displacement  
5% for 100% load step or removal  
Output Transients  
0.01 Hz free running  
Frequency Regulation  
Synchronous to Bypass  
Bypass within voltage limits of +5%, –8% of output setting;  
bypass within 0.5 Hz  
1 Hz per second maximum  
Frequency Slew Rate  
Overload Capability  
110% for 10 minutes  
125% for 30 seconds  
150% for 10 seconds  
15.2.3 Environmental  
0 to 40°C (32–104°F) without derating. The recommended  
operating temperature is 25°C (77°F).  
Operating Temperature  
Maximum 1500m (5000 ft) at 40°C without derating  
Operating Altitude  
–25 to +60°C, excluding batteries (prolonged storage above  
40°C causes rapid battery self-discharge)  
Storage Temperature  
5% to 95% maximum noncondensing  
Relative Humidity  
(operating and storage)  
65 dB at a 1m distance, c weighted  
Acoustical Noise  
EMI Suppression  
Meets FCC Regulation 47, Part 15, for class A devices  
Meets IEC 801-2 specifications. Withstands up to 25 kV pulse  
without damage and with no disturbance or adverse effect to  
the critical load.  
Electrostatic Discharge  
(ESD) Immunity  
®
15-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Product Specifications  
15.3 Multiple Module Parallel Specifications  
15.3.1 UPM Input  
Same as single module.  
15.3.2 UPM Output  
Same as single module.  
15.3.3 Environmental  
Same as single module.  
15.3.4 Battery  
Same as single module.  
15.3.5 Module Tie Cabinet Input  
208 Vac for operation from 177 Vac to 229 Vac  
220 Vac for operation from 187 Vac to 242 Vac  
480 Vac for operation from 408 Vac to 528 Vac  
Operating Input Voltage  
(UPM Dependent)  
See Appendix A, Table O through Table Q.  
Operating Input Current  
15.3.6 Module Tie Cabinet Output  
208 Vac for operation from 177 Vac to 229 Vac  
220 Vac for operation from 187 Vac to 242 Vac  
480 Vac for operation from 408 Vac to 528 Vac  
Operating Output Voltage  
(UPM Dependent)  
See Appendix A, Table O through Table Q.  
Operating Output Current  
®
15-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Product Specifications  
This page intentionally left blank.  
®
15-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix A Installation Information  
16-  
The information in this appendix is helpful during the planning and installation of  
the UPS system. This appendix contains the following drawings:  
Ī 164201604-1 Typical Powerware 9390 UPS System  
Ī 164201604-2 Physical Features and Requirements  
Ī 164201604-3 UPS System Oneline Configurations  
Ī 164201604-4 UPS System Oneline Drawing  
Ī 164201604-5 Power Wiring Installation Notes  
Ī 164201604-6 Conduit and Wire Entry Locations  
Ī 164201604-7 UPS Power Terminal Locations  
Ī 164201604-8 Interface Wiring Installation Notes and Terminal Locations  
Ī 164201604-9 UPS Cabinet Dimensions  
Ī 164201604-10 Optional Remote Emergency Power-off  
Ī 164201604-11 Optional Remote Monitor Panel  
Ī 164201604-12 Optional Remote Relay Interface Module  
Ī 164201604-13 Optional Remote Supervisory Contact Module  
®
A-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
BATTERY CABINET  
UPS CABINET  
DESCRIPTION:  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
TYPICAL POWERWARE 9390 UPS SYSTEM  
SHEET:  
164201604---1  
A
1 of 1  
DATE:  
091505  
®
A-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
1. The UPS equipment operating environment must meet the weight requirements shown in  
Table A and the size requirements shown on Drawing 164201604---9.  
2. The UPS cabinet is palleted separately for shipping.  
3. Do not tilt cabinets more than 10˚ during handling.  
4. Dimensions are in millimeters (inches).  
5. The cabinet can be installed in line-up-and-match or standalone configurations.  
Table A. UPS Cabinet Weight  
Weight  
kg (lb)  
Voltage  
Model  
Input  
208V/220V 208V/220V 531 (1170) 504 (1110) 6 at 84 (185)  
480V 480V 467 (1030) 440 (970) 6 at 73 (162)  
208V/220V 208V/220V 531 (1170) 553 (1110) 6 at 84 (185)  
480V 480V 467 (1030) 440 (970) 6 at 73 (162)  
208V/220V 208V/220V  
480V 480V  
208V/220V 208V/220V  
480V 480V  
208V/220V 208V/220V  
480V 480V  
Output  
Shipping  
Installed  
Point Loading  
Powerware 9390---120/100  
Powerware 9390---120/120  
Powerware 9390---160/100  
Powerware 9390---160/120  
Powerware 9390---160/160  
581 (1280) 553 (1220) 6 at 92 (204)  
581 (1280) 553 (1220) 6 at 92 (204)  
581 (1280) 553 (1220) 6 at 92 (204)  
6. The clearances required around the UPS cabinet are shown in Table B.  
Table B. UPS Cabinet Clearances  
From Top of Cabinet  
Minimum clearance over the UPS cabinet is  
457.2 mm (18 in.) for ventilation  
From Front of Cabinet  
From Back of Cabinet  
914.4 mm (36 inches) working space  
None required  
From Right Side of Cabinet  
From Left Side of Cabinet  
None required  
None required  
DESCRIPTION:  
PHYSICAL FEATURES AND REQUIREMENTS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---2  
1 of 2  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-3  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
7. The basic environmental requirements for operation of the UPS system are:  
Ambient Temperature Range: 0 --- 40˚C (32---104˚F)  
Recommended Operating Range: 20---25˚C (68---77˚F)  
Maximum Relative Humidity: 95%, noncondensing  
The UPS ventilation requirements are shown in Table C.  
Table C. Air Conditioning or Ventilation Requirements During Full Load Operation  
Voltage  
Heat Rejection  
Ratings  
BTU/hr ¢ 1000/hr (kg-cal/hr)  
Input  
208/220  
480  
Output  
208/220  
480  
100 kVA  
100 kVA  
120 kVA  
120 kVA  
160 kVA  
160 kVA  
29.6 (7.45)  
27.4 (6.90)  
35.5 (8.94)  
32.8 (8.28)  
47.3 (11.9)  
43.8 (11.0)  
208/220  
480  
208/220  
480  
208/220  
480  
208/220  
480  
Ventilation required for cooling air exhaust: approximately 9.44 liter/sec (2000 cfm).  
DESCRIPTION:  
PHYSICAL FEATURES AND REQUIREMENTS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---2  
2 of 2  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-4  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
Table D. UPS System Oneline Configurations  
Voltage  
Input Output  
Oneline Drawing  
164201604---4  
UPS  
Model  
System Type  
9390---120/100  
9390---120/120  
9390---160/100  
9390---160/120  
9390---160/160  
208/220 208/220  
Single Module --- Reverse Transfer  
Single-Feed or Dual-Feed  
Sheet 1  
Sheet 2  
Sheet 3  
Sheet 4  
Sheet 5  
480  
480  
9390---120/100  
9390---120/120  
9390---160/100  
9390---160/120  
9390---160/160  
208/220 208/220  
Single Module --- Reverse Transfer  
Single-Feed with Typical  
Maintenance Bypass Panel  
480  
480  
9390---120/100  
9390---120/120  
9390---160/100  
9390---160/120  
9390---160/160  
208/220 208/220  
Multiple Module --- Parallel  
Single-Feed or Dual-Feed  
1+1 and 2+0 Configurations  
480  
480  
9390---120/100  
9390---120/120  
9390---160/100  
9390---160/120  
9390---160/160  
208/220 208/220  
Multiple Module --- Parallel  
Single-Feed or Dual-Feed  
2+1 and 3+0 Configurations  
480  
480  
9390---120/100  
9390---120/120  
9390---160/100  
9390---160/120  
9390---160/160  
208/220 208/220  
Multiple Module --- Parallel  
Single-Feed or Dual-Feed  
3+1 and 4+0 Configurations  
480  
480  
DESCRIPTION:  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
UPS SYSTEM ONELINE CONFIGURATIONS  
SHEET:  
164201604---3  
A
1 of 1  
DATE:  
091505  
®
A-5  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
AC INPUT TO  
UPS RECTIFIER AND BYPASS  
(SINGLE-FEED )  
3 or 4 WIRE A --- B --- C  
ROTATION  
(See Drawing 164201604---8)  
AC INPUT TO  
UPS RECTIFIER  
(DUAL FEED)  
AC INPUT  
TO BYPASS  
(DUAL FEED)  
BUILDING ALARMS  
ALARM RELAY  
BATTERY AUX  
BATTERY UVR  
3 WIRE A --- B --- C  
3 or 4 WIRE A --- B --- C  
ROTATION  
ROTATION  
X-SLOT  
INTERFACE  
REMOTE EPO  
B
A
E1, E2, E3  
E6, E7, E8, E12  
INTERFACE  
BOARD  
BACKFEED  
CONTACTOR  
(K5)  
SEE NOTE 2  
FUSE  
INPUT  
CONTACTOR  
(K1)  
FUSE  
STATIC  
SWITCH  
BATTERY  
CABINET  
(Optional)  
UPS CABINET  
RECTIFIER  
C
E4. E5  
D
AC OUTPUT  
TO  
E9, E10,  
E11, E12  
CRITICAL LOAD  
BATTERY  
CONVERTER  
OUTPUT  
CONTACTOR  
(K3)  
BATTERY  
BREAKER  
INVERTER  
FUSE  
POWERWARE 9390 120/100 AND  
120/120 408V INPUT AND 480V OUTPUT  
UPS SYSTEM  
SINGLE-FEED OR DUAL-FEED  
NOTE: 1. A minimum of two separate feeds with  
upstream feeder breakers, or one feed  
with two upstream feeder breakers, must  
be provided: one for the UPS and one  
for the IAC bypass input. DO NOT use  
one feed or a single-feeder breaker to  
supply both the UPS and the IAC.  
DESCRIPTION:  
2. Remove jumpers for dual-feed.  
UPS SYSTEM ONELINE DRAWING  
3. If the load requires a neutral, a bypass  
neutral feeder must be supplied.  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---4  
B
1 of 6  
DATE:  
032406  
®
A-6  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
AC INPUT TO  
UPS RECTIFIER AND BYPASS  
(SINGLE-FEED)  
3 or 4 WIRE A --- B --- C  
ROTATION  
(See Drawing 164201604---8)  
AC INPUT TO  
UPS RECTIFIER  
(DUAL FEED)  
AC INPUT  
TO BYPASS  
(DUAL FEED)  
BUILDING ALARMS  
ALARM RELAY  
BATTERY AUX  
BATTERY UVR  
3 WIRE A --- B --- C  
3 or 4 WIRE A --- B --- C  
ROTATION  
ROTATION  
X-SLOT  
INTERFACE  
REMOTE EPO  
B
A
E1, E2, E3  
E6, E7, E8, E12  
INTERFACE  
BOARD  
BACKFEED  
CONTACTOR  
(K5)  
FUSE  
INPUT  
FUSE  
CONTACTOR  
(K1)  
STATIC  
SWITCH  
BATTERY  
CABINET  
RECTIFIER  
UPS CABINET  
(Optional)  
C
E4. E5  
D
AC OUTPUT  
TO  
E9, E10,  
E11, E12  
CRITICAL LOAD  
BATTERY  
CONVERTER  
OUTPUT  
CONTACTOR  
(K3)  
BATTERY  
BREAKER  
INVERTER  
FUSE  
SERIAL NUMBER SEVENTH  
DIGIT AT A”  
POWERWARE 9390 120/100, 120/120, 160/100 160/120  
AND 160/160 208/220V INPUT AND OUTPUT AND  
160/100, 160/120 AND 160/160 480V INPUT AND OUTPUT  
UPS SYSTEM  
NOTE: 1. A minimum of two separate feeds with  
upstream feeder breakers, or one feed  
with two upstream feeder breakers, must  
be provided: one for the UPS and one  
for the IAC bypass input. DO NOT use  
one feed or a single-feeder breaker to  
supply both the UPS and the IAC.  
SINGLE-FEED OR DUAL-FEED  
2. Move bypass contactor wires to  
bypass terminals for dual-feed.  
DESCRIPTION:  
UPS SYSTEM ONELINE DRAWING  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
2 of 6  
3. If the load requires a neutral, a bypass  
neutral feeder must be supplied.  
164201604---4  
DATE:  
D
032406  
®
A-7  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
AC INPUT  
To UPS  
Input  
MBP  
MIB  
CRITICAL LOAD  
DISTRIBUTION  
UNIT  
Output  
from  
UPS  
MAINTENANCE  
BYPASS PANEL  
(PROVIDED BY OTHERS)  
K5  
STATIC  
SWITCH  
Backfeed  
K3  
UPS  
BATTERY  
BREAKER  
BATTERY CABINET  
MIB:  
MAINTENANCE ISOLATION BREAKER  
MAINTENANCE BYPASS BREAKER  
MBP:  
TYPICAL MAINTENANCE BYPASS PANEL POWER FLOW  
If installing, as part of the UPS system, a maintenance bypass without a rectifier input  
breaker, a minimum of two separate feeds with upstream feeder breakers, or one feed  
with two upstream feeder breakers, must be provided: one for the UPS and one for the  
maintenance bypass input. DO NOT use one feed or a single-feeder breaker to supply  
both the UPS and the maintenance bypass.  
NOTE:  
DESCRIPTION:  
UPS SYSTEM ONELINE DRAWING  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---4  
3 of 6  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-8  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
A
A
E
B
B
*
*
*
*
UPM 2  
UPM 1  
E1  
E2  
E3  
E6E  
7E8  
E12  
E1  
E2  
E3  
E6E  
7E8  
E12  
SEE NOTE 2  
SEE NOTE 2  
K5  
K5  
K1  
K1  
FUSE  
FUSE  
FUSE  
FUSE  
RECTIFIER  
RECTIFIER  
STATIC  
SWITCH  
STATIC  
SWITCH  
F
BATTERY  
CONVERTER  
BATTERY  
CONVERTER  
MODULE TIE  
CABINET  
(OPTIONAL)  
MBP  
INVERTER  
FUSE  
INVERTER  
FUSE  
K3  
K3  
E4. E5  
E4. E5  
C
C
BATTERY  
BREAKER  
BATTERY  
BREAKER  
E9  
E9  
E10  
E11  
E12  
E10  
E11  
E12  
BATTERY CABINET  
BATTERY CABINET  
MOB 1  
MOB 2  
D
D
A -- AC Input to UPS Rectifier and Bypass (single-feed) and UPS Rectifier (dual-feed)  
B -- AC Input to UPS Bypass (dual-feed)  
C -- DC Input from Battery  
D -- UPM AC Output to Parallel Tie Point  
E -- AC Input Source  
F -- System Bypass Input  
MIS  
G -- Output to Critical Load  
* --  
Overcurrent Protection Provided by Others  
G
NOTE: 1. UPM and system bypass input feeds  
TYPICAL PARALLEL SYSTEM  
(1+1 AND 2+0 CONFIGURATIONS)  
OUTPUT TO  
CRITICAL LOAD  
must come from the same source.  
DESCRIPTION:  
2. Remove jumper for dual-feed.  
UPS SYSTEM ONELINE DRAWING  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
4 of 6  
164201604---4  
3. See Note 27 on page A---21 for  
neutral bonding instructions.  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-9  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
A
A
A
E
B
B
B
*
*
*
*
*
*
UPM 3  
UPM 2  
UPM 1  
E1  
E2  
E3  
E6E  
7E8  
E12  
E1  
E2  
E3  
E6E  
7E8  
E12  
E1  
E2  
E3  
E6E  
7E8  
E12  
SEE NOTE 2  
SEE NOTE 2  
SEE NOTE 2  
K5  
K5  
K5  
K1  
K1  
K1  
FUSE  
FUSE  
FUSE  
FUSE  
FUSE  
FUSE  
RECTIFIER  
RECTIFIER  
RECTIFIER  
STATIC  
SWITCH  
STATIC  
SWITCH  
STATIC  
SWITCH  
F
BATTERY  
CONVERTER  
BATTERY  
CONVERTER  
BATTERY  
CONVERTER  
MODULE TIE  
CABINET  
(OPTIONAL)  
MBP  
INVERTER  
FUSE  
INVERTER  
FUSE  
INVERTER  
FUSE  
K3  
K3  
K3  
E4. E5  
E4. E5  
E4. E5  
C
C
C
BATTERY  
BREAKER  
BATTERY  
BREAKER  
BATTERY  
BREAKER  
E9  
E9  
E9  
E10  
E11  
E12  
E10  
E11  
E12  
E10  
E11  
E12  
BATTERY CABINET  
BATTERY CABINET  
BATTERY CABINET  
MOB 1  
MOB 2  
MOB 3  
D
D
D
A -- AC Input to UPS Rectifier and Bypass (single-feed) and UPS Rectifier (dual-feed)  
B -- AC Input to UPS Bypass (dual-feed)  
C -- DC Input from Battery  
D -- UPM AC Output to Parallel Tie Point  
E -- AC Input Source  
MIS  
F -- System Bypass Input  
G -- Output to Critical Load  
G
* --  
Overcurrent Protection Provided by Others  
TYPICAL PARALLEL SYSTEM  
(2+1 AND 3+0 CONFIGURATIONS)  
NOTE: 1. UPM and system bypass input feeds  
OUTPUT TO  
CRITICAL LOAD  
must come from the same source.  
2. Remove jumper for dual-feed.  
DESCRIPTION:  
UPS SYSTEM ONELINE DRAWING  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
5 of 6  
3. See Note 27 on page A---21 for  
neutral bonding instructions.  
164201604---4  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-10  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
A
A
A
A
E
B
B
B
B
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
UPM 4  
UPM 3  
UPM 2  
UPM 1  
E1  
E2  
E3  
E6E  
7E8  
E12  
E1  
E2  
E3  
E6E  
7E8  
E12  
E1  
E2  
E3  
E6E  
7E8  
E12  
E1  
E2  
E3  
E6E  
7E8  
E12  
SEE NOTE 2  
SEE NOTE 2  
SEE NOTE 2  
SEE NOTE 2  
K5  
K5  
K5  
K5  
K1  
K1  
K1  
K1  
FUSE  
FUSE  
FUSE  
FUSE  
FUSE  
FUSE  
FUSE  
FUSE  
RECTIFIER  
RECTIFIER  
RECTIFIER  
RECTIFIER  
STATIC  
SWITCH  
STATIC  
SWITCH  
STATIC  
SWITCH  
STATIC  
SWITCH  
F
BATTERY  
CONVERTER  
BATTERY  
CONVERTER  
BATTERY  
CONVERTER  
BATTERY  
CONVERTER  
MODULE TIE  
CABINET  
(OPTIONAL)  
MBP  
INVERTER  
FUSE  
INVERTER  
FUSE  
INVERTER  
FUSE  
INVERTER  
FUSE  
K3  
K3  
K3  
K3  
E4. E5  
E4. E5  
E4. E5  
E4. E5  
C
C
C
C
BATTERY  
BREAKER  
BATTERY  
BREAKER  
BATTERY  
BREAKER  
BATTERY  
BREAKER  
E9  
E9  
E9  
E9  
E10  
E11  
E12  
E10  
E11  
E12  
E10  
E11  
E12  
E10  
E11  
E12  
BATTERY CABINET  
BATTERY CABINET  
BATTERY CABINET  
BATTERY CABINET  
MOB 1  
MOB 2  
D
D
D
D
MOB 3  
MOB 4  
A -- AC Input to UPS Rectifier and Bypass (single-feed) and UPS Rectifier (dual-feed)  
B -- AC Input to UPS Bypass (dual-feed)  
C -- DC Input from Battery  
D -- UPM AC Output to Parallel Tie Point  
E -- AC Input Source  
MIS  
F -- System Bypass Input  
G -- Output to Critical Load  
* --  
Overcurrent Protection Provided by Others  
G
TYPICAL PARALLEL SYSTEM  
(3+1 AND 4+0 CONFIGURATIONS)  
NOTE: 1. UPM and system bypass input feeds  
OUTPUT TO  
CRITICAL LOAD  
must come from the same source.  
DESCRIPTION:  
2. Remove jumper for dual-feed.  
UPS SYSTEM ONELINE DRAWING  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
6 of 6  
164201604---4  
3. See Note 27 on page A---21 for  
neutral bonding instructions.  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-11  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
Table E. INPUT/OUTPUT Ratings & External Wiring Requirements for the Powerware  
9390---120/100 and 9390---160/100  
Units  
Rating 50/60 Hz  
kVA  
kW  
100  
90  
100  
90  
Basic Unit Rating at 0.9 lagging pF load  
Input and Bypass Input  
Output  
VOLTS  
VOLTS  
208/220  
208/220  
480  
480  
AC Input to UPS Rectifier (0.98 min. pF)  
Full Load Current plus Battery Recharge Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Ground  
Amps  
300  
130  
A
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number per Phase  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
3/0  
(2)  
4/0  
(1)  
AC Input to UPS Bypass  
Full Load Current  
Amps  
278/262  
120  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
B
C
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number per Phase  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
3/0  
(2)  
4/0  
(1)  
DC Input from Battery to UPS  
(1) Positive, (1) Negative  
Vdc  
384---480  
252  
432---480  
252  
Amps@ (2.0V/cell)  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number per Pole  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
2/0  
(2)  
2/0  
(2)  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
Amps  
278/262  
120  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
D
---  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number per Phase  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
3/0  
(2)  
4/0  
(1)  
Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 7)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
1/0  
(1)  
2
(1)  
NOTE: Callout letters A, B, C, and D map to Drawing 164201604---4, sheets 1 of 6,  
2 of 6, 4 of 6, 5 of 6, and 6 of 6.  
Read and understand the following notes while planning and performing the installation:  
1. Refer to national and local electrical codes for acceptable external wiring practices.  
2. Material and labor for external wiring requirements are to be provided by designated  
personnel.  
3. For external wiring, use 90° C copper wire. See the appropriate information in Table E  
through Table G. Wire sizes are based on using the specified breakers.  
4. Wire ampacities are chosen from Table 310---16 of the NEC. Wire is 90°C specification.  
5. If installing, as part of the UPS system, a maintenance bypass without a rectifier input  
breaker, a minimum of two separate feeds with upstream feeder breakers, or one feed with  
two upstream feeder breakers, must be provided: one for the UPS and one for the  
maintenance bypass input. DO NOT use one feed or a single-feeder breaker to supply  
both the UPS and the maintenance bypass.  
DESCRIPTION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---5  
B
1 of 15  
DATE:  
032406  
®
A-12  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
Table F. INPUT/OUTPUT Ratings & External Wiring Requirements for the Powerware  
9390---120/120 and 9390---160/120  
Units  
Rating 50/60 Hz  
kVA  
kW  
120  
108  
120  
108  
Basic Unit Rating at 0.9 lagging pF load  
Input and Bypass Input  
Output  
VOLTS  
VOLTS  
208/220  
208/220  
480  
480  
AC Input to UPS Rectifier (0.98 min. pF)  
Full Load Current plus Battery Recharge Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Ground  
Amps  
360  
160  
A
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number per Phase  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
4/0  
(2)  
4/0  
(1)  
AC Input to UPS Bypass  
Full Load Current  
Amps  
333/315  
144  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
B
C
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number per Phase  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
4/0  
(2)  
4/0  
(1)  
DC Input from Battery to UPS  
(1) Positive, (1) Negative  
Vdc  
384---480  
302  
432---480  
302  
Amps@ (2.0V/cell)  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number per Pole  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
3/0  
(2)  
3/0  
(2)  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
Amps  
333/315  
144  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
D
---  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number per Phase  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
4/0  
(2)  
4/0  
(1)  
Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 7)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
1/0  
(1)  
2
(1)  
NOTE: Callout letters A, B, C, and D map to Drawing 164201604---4, sheets 1 of 6,  
2 of 6, 4 of 6, 5 of 6, and 6 of 6.  
6. The bypass feed into this equipment uses three or four wires. The rectifier feed into this  
equipment uses three wires. The phases must be symmetrical about ground (from a Wye  
source) for proper equipment operation.  
7. If the load requires a neutral, a bypass source neutral must be provided. If the load does  
not require a neutral and there is no neutral conductor connected at the bypass input, a  
neutral to ground bonding jumper must be installed. DO NOT install both a source neutral  
and a bonding jumper. See Table E through Table G for neutral bonding jumper wire sizes.  
Bonding jumper must be copper wire.  
C A U T I O N  
HIGH IMPEDANCE GROUND SOURCES - If the source of supply is a high impedance ground (IT)  
type, the input neutral conductor must be connected from the source of supply. If there is no  
output neutral connected to the UPS, the neutral-forming tranformer kit (PN 103005400) may  
be used instead of pulling a neutral from the source. If the load requires a neutral then an  
input neutral conductor must be pulled into the UPS. In no circumstances shall a neutral to  
ground bonding jumper be installed in the UPS.  
DESCRIPTION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---5  
2 of 15  
DATE:  
B
032406  
®
A-13  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
Table G. INPUT/OUTPUT Ratings & External Wiring Requirements for the Powerware  
9390---160/160  
Units  
Rating 50/60 Hz  
kVA  
kW  
160  
144  
160  
144  
Basic Unit Rating at 0.9 lagging pF load  
Input and Bypass Input  
Output  
VOLTS  
VOLTS  
208/220  
208/220  
480  
480  
AC Input to UPS Rectifier (0.98 min. pF)  
Full Load Current plus Battery Recharge Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Ground  
Amps  
480  
210  
A
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number per Phase  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
400  
(2)  
1/0  
(2)  
AC Input to UPS Bypass  
Full Load Current  
Amps  
444/420  
192  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
B
C
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number per Phase  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
400  
(2)  
1/0  
(2)  
DC Input from Battery to UPS  
(1) Positive, (1) Negative  
Vdc  
384---480  
403  
432---480  
403  
Amps@ (2.0V/cell)  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number per Pole  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
250  
(2)  
250  
(2)  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
Amps  
444/420  
192  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
D
---  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number per Phase  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
400  
(2)  
1/0  
(2)  
Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 7)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
1/0  
(2)  
2
(2)  
NOTE: Callout letters A, B, C, and D map to Drawing 164201604---4, sheets 1 of 6,  
2 of 6, 4 of 6, 5 of 6, and 6 of 6.  
C A U T I O N  
DELTA SOURCES (TN-S) - The Powerware 9390 UPS system can be operated only from a delta  
supply source that is fully floating and if the neutral-forming transformer kit (PN 103005400) is  
installed in the UPS. The UPS cannot be operated from a mid-point or end-point grounded  
delta supply source. With this type of supply source, there is no capability to provide an output  
neutral. In no circumstances shall a neutral to ground bonding jumper be installed in the UPS.  
8. The UPS cabinet is shipped with a debris shield covering the ventilation grill on top of the  
unit. Do not remove the debris shield until installation is complete. However, remove the  
shield before operating the UPS. Once the debris shield is removed, do not place objects  
on the ventilation grill.  
9. Refer to Section I of this manual for installation instructions.  
DESCRIPTION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
3 of 15  
164201604---5  
DATE:  
B
032406  
®
A-14  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
10. Terminals are UL and CSA rated at 90˚C. Refer to Table H and Table I for power cable  
terminations, and Table J for conduit requirements. Drawing 164201604---7 shows the  
location of the power cable terminals inside the UPS cabinet.  
Table H. UPS Cabinet Power Cable Terminations for the Powerware 9390---120/100 and  
9390---120/120 (480V Input and 480V Output)  
Tightening  
Size of Pressure  
Termination  
Type  
Screw  
Terminal Function  
Terminal Function  
Torque  
Nm (lb in)  
42.4 (375)  
42.4 (375)  
42.4 (375)  
42.4 (375)  
42.4 (375)  
42.4 (375)  
42.4 (375)  
42.4 (375)  
42.4 (375)  
12.5 (110)  
22.6 (200)  
12.5 (110)  
22.6 (200)  
12.5 (110)  
22.6 (200)  
42.4 (375)  
42.4 (375)  
42.4 (375)  
56.5 (500)  
56.5 (500)  
42.4 (375)  
5.6 (50)  
E1  
E2  
E3  
E1  
E2  
E3  
E6  
E7  
E8  
Phase A 2 --- #6 --- 250 kcmil  
Phase B 2 --- #6 --- 250 kcmil  
Phase C 2 --- #6 --- 250 kcmil  
Phase A 2 --- #6 --- 250 kcmil  
Phase B 2 --- #6 --- 250 kcmil  
Phase C 2 --- #6 --- 250 kcmil  
Phase A 2 --- #6 --- 250 kcmil  
Phase B 2 --- #6 --- 250 kcmil  
Phase C 2 --- #6 --- 250 kcmil  
5/16 in. Hex  
5/16 in. Hex  
5/16 in. Hex  
5/16 in. Hex  
5/16 in. Hex  
5/16 in. Hex  
5/16 in. Hex  
5/16 in. Hex  
5/16 in. Hex  
M8 Hex Bolt  
M10 Hex Bolt  
M8 Hex Bolt  
M10 Hex Bolt  
M8 Hex Bolt  
M10 Hex Bolt  
5/16 in. Hex  
5/16 in. Hex  
5/16 in. Hex  
1/2 in. Hex  
AC Input to UPS Rectifier  
and Bypass  
(Single Input)  
AC Input to UPS Rectifier  
(Dual Input)  
AC Input To Bypass  
(Dual Input)  
Rectifier Phase A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
Single-Feed To Dual-Feed  
Remove Jumpers between  
Rectifier Input Terminals  
and Bypass Input  
Bypass  
Rectifier Phase B  
Bypass Phase B  
Rectifier Phase C  
Bypass  
E9  
E10  
E11  
E4  
E5  
Phase A  
Terminals  
Phase C  
Phase A 2 --- #6 --- 250 kcmil  
Phase B 2 --- #6 --- 250 kcmil  
Phase C 2 --- #6 --- 250 kcmil  
AC Output to  
Critical Load  
Positive  
2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmil  
DC Input from  
Battery to UPS  
Negative 2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmil  
1/2 in. Hex  
5/16 in. Hex  
Slotted  
Input and Output Neutral  
Customer Ground  
E12  
Ground  
Neutral  
Ground  
8 --- #6 --- 250 kcmil  
8 --- #14 --- 1/0  
NOTE: Customer ground can be run in any conduit listed in Table J.  
DESCRIPTION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
4 of 15  
164201604---5  
DATE:  
B
032406  
®
A-15  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
Table I. UPS Cabinet Power Cable Terminations for the Powerware 9390---120/100,  
9390---120/120, 9390---160/100, 9390---160/120, and 9390---160/160 (208V/220V Input and  
208V/220V Output), and the Powerware 9390---160/100, 9390---160/120, and 9390---160/160  
(480V Input and 480V Output)  
Tightening  
Size of Pressure  
Termination  
Type  
Screw  
Terminal Function  
Terminal Function  
Torque  
Nm (lb in)  
56.5 (500)  
56.5 (500)  
56.5 (500)  
56.5 (500)  
56.5 (500)  
56.5 (500)  
56.5 (500)  
56.5 (500)  
56.5 (500)  
12.5 (110)  
12.5 (110)  
12.5 (110)  
12.5 (110)  
12.5 (110)  
12.5 (110)  
56.5 (500)  
56.5 (500)  
56.5 (500)  
56.5 (500)  
56.5 (500)  
56.5 (500)  
5.6 (50)  
E1  
E2  
E3  
E1  
E2  
E3  
E6  
E7  
E8  
Phase A 2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmil  
Phase B 2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmill  
Phase C 2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmil  
Phase A 2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmil  
Phase B 2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmil  
Phase C 2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmill  
Phase A 2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmil  
Phase B 2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmil  
Phase C 2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmil  
1/2 in. Hex  
1/2 in. Hex  
1/2 in. Hex  
1/2 in. Hex  
1/2 in. Hex  
1/2 in. Hex  
1/2 in. Hex  
1/2 in. Hex  
1/2 in. Hex  
M8 Hex Bolt  
M8 Hex Bolt  
M8 Hex Bolt  
M8 Hex Bolt  
M8 Hex Bolt  
M8 Hex Bolt  
1/2 in. Hex  
1/2 in. Hex  
1/2 in. Hex  
1/2 in. Hex  
1/2 in. Hex  
1/2 in. Hex  
Slotted  
AC Input to UPS Rectifier  
and Bypass  
(Single Input)  
AC Input to UPS Rectifier  
(Dual Input)  
AC Input To Bypass  
(Dual Input)  
Rectifier Phase A  
Bypass Phase A  
Rectifier Phase B  
Bypass Phase B  
Rectifier Phase C  
Bypass  
E9  
E10  
E11  
E4  
E5  
E12  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
Single-Feed to Dual-Feed  
Transfer Wires from  
Rectifier Input Terminals  
to Bypass Input Terminals  
Phase C  
Phase A 2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmil  
Phase B 2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmil  
Phase C 2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmill  
AC Output to  
Critical Load  
Positive  
2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmil  
DC Input from  
Battery to UPS  
Negative 2 --- #2 --- 600 kcmil  
Input and Output Neutral  
Customer Ground  
Neutral  
Ground  
8 --- #2 --- 600 kcmil  
8 --- #14 --- 1/0  
Ground  
NOTE: Customer ground can be run in any conduit listed in Table J.  
DESCRIPTION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---5  
5 of 15  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-16  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
11. Per NEC article 300-20(a), all three-phase conductors must be run in the same conduit.  
Neutral and ground must be run in the same conduit as the phase conductors.  
12. Conduit is sized to accommodate one neutral conductor the same size as the phase  
conductor and one #8 AWG ground conductor. If two neutral conductors or an oversized  
neutral conductor are to be installed, check the size of the conduit needed to  
accommodate the extra wire or size and use that conduit size in place of the conduit size  
listed in Table J. All Powerware 9390 products can accommodate a double size neutral.  
13. Conduit sizes were chosen from NEC Table C1, type letters RHH, RHW, RHW-2, TW, THW,  
THHW, THW-2.  
Table J. Power Cable Conduit Requirements  
Number of  
Wires in  
Conduit  
Minimum Conduit  
Trade Size (inches)  
Number of  
Conduits  
UPS Model  
Voltage  
Terminal  
AC Input to UPS  
(A, B, C, Gnd)  
AC Input to Bypass  
(A, B, C, Neut, Gnd)  
Output  
(A, B, C, Neut, Gnd)  
4
5
5
5
4
5
5
5
4
5
5
5
4
5
5
5
2-1/2  
2-1/2  
2-1/2  
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
1
2
2
2
1
208/220  
AC  
Powerware  
9390---120/100  
and  
9390---160/100  
Battery  
(Positive), (Negative), Gnd  
DC  
AC Input to UPS  
(A, B, C, Gnd)  
AC Input to Bypass  
(A, B, C, Neut, Gnd)  
Output  
(A, B, C, Neut, Gnd)  
2-1/2  
2-1/2  
2-1/2  
2
480  
AC  
Powerware  
9390---120/100  
and  
9390---160/100  
Battery  
(Positive), (Negative), Gnd  
DC  
AC Input to UPS  
(A, B, C, Gnd)  
AC Input to Bypass  
(A, B, C, Neut, Gnd)  
Output  
(A, B, C, Neut, Gnd)  
2-1/2  
2-1/2  
2-1/2  
2
208/220  
AC  
Powerware  
9390---120/120  
and  
9390---160/120  
Battery  
(Positive), (Negative), Gnd  
DC  
AC Input to UPS  
(A, B, C, Gnd)  
AC Input to Bypass  
(A, B, C, Neut, Gnd)  
Output  
(A, B, C, Neut, Gnd)  
1-1/2  
1-1/2  
1-1/2  
2
480  
AC  
Powerware  
9390---120/120  
and  
9390---160/120  
Battery  
(Positive), (Negative), Gnd  
DC  
DESCRIPTION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
6 of 15  
164201604---5  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-17  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
Table J. Power Cable Conduit Requirements (Cont’d)  
Number of  
Wires in  
Conduit  
Minimum Conduit  
Trade Size (inches)  
Number of  
Conduits  
UPS Model  
Voltage  
Terminal  
AC Input to UPS  
(A, B, C, Gnd)  
AC Input to Bypass  
(A, B, C, Neut, Gnd)  
Output  
(A, B, C, Neut, Gnd)  
4
5
5
5
4
5
5
5
3-1/2  
3-1/2  
3-1/2  
2-1/2  
2
2
2
2
1
2
2
2
1
208/220  
AC  
Powerware  
9390---160/160  
Battery  
(Positive), (Negative), Gnd  
DC  
AC Input to UPS  
(A, B, C, Gnd)  
AC Input to Bypass  
(A, B, C, Neut, Gnd)  
Output  
(A, B, C, Neut, Gnd)  
480  
AC  
2
Powerware  
9390---160/160  
2
Battery  
(Positive), (Negative), Gnd  
2-1/2  
DC  
DESCRIPTION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---5  
7 of 15  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-18  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
14. External overcurrent protection is not provided by this product, but is required by codes.  
Refer to Table E through Table G for wiring requirements. If an output lockable disconnect  
is required, it is to be supplied by the user.  
15. Table K lists the maximum rating for input circuit breakers. When wiring a single-feed input,  
the rating requirements for the input circuit breakers are superceded by the ratings listed in  
Table L.  
Table K. Maximum Input Circuit Breaker Ratings  
Input Voltage Rating  
UPS Model  
208V/220V  
450A  
480V  
200A  
150A  
225A  
175A  
300A  
250A  
80% Rated  
100% Rated  
80% Rated  
100% Rated  
80% Rated  
100% Rated  
Powerware 9390---120/100  
Powerware 9390---160/100  
350A  
500A  
450A  
700A  
Powerware 9390---120/120  
Powerware 9390---160/120  
Powerware 9390---160/160  
600A  
C A U T I O N  
To reduce the risk of fire, connect only to a circuit provided with maximum input  
circuit breaker current ratings from Table K in accordance with the National Electrical  
code, ANSI/NFPA 70.  
16. Source protection for the AC input to bypass should be treated as if supplying a 160 kVA  
three-phase transformer, to allow for inrush current if an IDC with a transformer is installed.  
Bypass input wiring and bypass input breaker rating should be treated as if supplying a  
160 kVA load, regardless of the rating of the UPS.  
17. The line-to-line unbalanced output capability of the UPS is limited only by the full load  
per phase current values for AC output to critical load shown in Table E through Table G.  
The recommended line-to-line load unbalance is 50% or less.  
18. Bypass and output overcurrent protection and bypass and output disconnect switches are  
to be provided by the user. Table L lists the maximum rating for bypass and output circuit  
breakers satisfying the criteria for both.  
Table L. Maximum Bypass and Output Circuit Breaker Ratings  
Output Voltage Rating  
UPS Model  
208V/220V  
450A  
480V  
200A  
150A  
225A  
175A  
300A  
250A  
80% Rated  
100% Rated  
80% Rated  
100% Rated  
80% Rated  
100% Rated  
Powerware 9390---120/100  
Powerware 9390---160/100  
350A  
500A  
Powerware 9390---120/120  
Powerware 9390---160/120  
450A  
700A  
Powerware 9390---160/160  
600A  
DESCRIPTION:  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
SHEET:  
8 of 15  
164201604---5  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-19  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
19. There is no DC disconnect device within the UPS.  
20. A battery disconnect switch is recommended, and may be required by NEC or local codes  
when batteries are remotely located. The battery disconnect switch should be installed  
between the battery and the UPS.  
21. External DC input overcurrent protection and disconnect switch for the remote battery  
location is to be provided by the user. Table M lists the maximum rating for continuous-duty  
rated circuit breakers satisfying the criteria for both.  
Table M. Maximum DC Input Circuit Breaker Ratings  
Input Voltage Rating  
UPS Model  
208V/220V  
480V  
Powerware 9390---120/100  
Powerware 9390---160/100  
400A  
400A  
Powerware 9390---120/120  
Powerware 9390---160/120  
Powerware 9390---160/160  
450A  
600A  
450A  
600A  
22. Battery voltage is computed at 2 volts per cell as defined by Article 480 of the NEC.  
Rated battery current is computed at 2 volts per cell.  
23. The battery wiring used between the battery and the UPS should not allow a voltage drop  
of more than 1% of nominal DC voltage at rated battery current.  
24. If the conductors used for DC input from the battery cabinets to the UPS are those  
provided by the UPS manufacturer, and the UPS and battery cabinets are manufactured by  
the same supplier, then it is acceptable if they do not meet the noted minimum conductor  
sizes.  
DESCRIPTION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
9 of 15  
164201604---5  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-20  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
25. Parallel system UPM and system bypass input feeds must come from the same source.  
26. Parallel UPM input wiring size requirements and output wiring size requirements from the  
UPMs to the tie cabinet or distribution panel are the same as listed in Table E through  
Table G.  
27. If the load requires a neutral, a bypass source neutral must be provided. If the load does  
not require a neutral and there is no neutral conductor connected at the bypass input, a  
neutral to ground bonding jumper must be installed. Install neutral conductors from the  
UPMs to the common point of connection (tie cabinet), and then install a system neutral to  
ground bonding jumper. If the recommended installation method cannot be accomplished,  
each UPM should have a separate neutral to ground bonding jumper installed in  
accordance with Note 7 on page A---13. DO NOT install both a source neutral and a  
bonding jumper. See Table O through Table Q for system neutral bonding jumper wire  
sizes. Bonding jumper must be copper wire.  
C A U T I O N  
HIGH IMPEDANCE GROUND SOURCES - If the source of supply is a high impedance ground (IT)  
type, the input neutral conductor must be connected from the source of supply. If there is no  
output neutral connected to the UPS, the neutral-forming tranformer kit (PN 103005400) may  
be used instead of pulling a neutral from the source. If the load requires a neutral then an  
input neutral conductor must be pulled into the UPS. In no circumstances shall a neutral to  
ground bonding jumper be installed in the UPS.  
C A U T I O N  
DELTA SOURCES (TN-S) - The Powerware 9390 UPS system can be operated only from a delta  
supply source that is fully floating and if the neutral-forming transformer kit (PN 103005400) is  
installed in the UPS. The UPS cannot be operated from a mid-point or end-point grounded  
delta supply source. With this type of supply source, there is no capability to provide an output  
neutral. In no circumstances shall a neutral to ground bonding jumper be installed in the UPS.  
DESCRIPTION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
10 of 15  
164201604---5  
DATE:  
B
032406  
®
A-21  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
28. See Drawing 164201604---7 for UPM terminal locations and Table H or Table I for  
termination requirements.  
29. Setup of the CAN Bridge card for parallel operation must be performed by an authorized  
Eaton Customer Service Engineer. Contact service to schedule a date.  
30. For parallel system circuit breaker ratings, see appropriate information in Table N.  
31. For parallel system ratings, see the appropriate information in Table O through Table Q.  
Table N. Recommended UPM Output (MOB), Main Output (MIS), and Bypass (MBP)  
Circuit Breaker Ratings  
Output Voltage  
208V/220V  
MIS  
480V  
MIS  
200  
400  
600  
800  
200  
400  
600  
800  
250  
500  
800  
1000  
UPM Model  
Configuration  
MOB  
500  
500  
500  
500  
500  
500  
500  
500  
600  
600  
600  
600  
MBP  
500  
MOB  
200  
200  
200  
200  
200  
200  
200  
200  
250  
250  
250  
250  
MBP  
200  
400  
600  
800  
200  
400  
600  
800  
250  
500  
800  
1000  
1+1  
2+0 and 2+1  
3+0 and 3+1  
4+0  
500  
1000  
1600  
2000  
500  
1000  
1600  
2000  
500  
9390---120/100  
9390---160/100  
1+1  
2+0 and 2+1  
3+0 and 3+1  
4+0  
1000  
1600  
2000  
600  
1000  
1600  
2000  
600  
9390---120/120  
9390---160/120  
1+1  
2+0 and 2+1  
3+0 and 3+1  
4+0  
1200  
2000  
2400  
1200  
2000  
2400  
9390---160/160  
DESCRIPTION:  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
SHEET:  
11 of 15  
164201604---5  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-22  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
Table O. INPUT/OUTPUT Ratings for Powerware 9390---120/100 and 9390---160/100 Parallel Systems  
Configuration  
Units  
Rating 50/60 Hz  
kVA  
kW  
100  
90  
100  
90  
Basic Unit Rating at 0.9 lagging pF load  
Input and Bypass Input  
Output  
VOLTS  
VOLTS  
208/220  
208/220  
480  
480  
AC Input from UPM  
Full Load Current for each Module  
Amps  
278/262  
120  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
All  
D
F
Minimum Conductor Size for each Module  
Number per Phase for each Module  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
See Table E through  
Table G for wire size.  
AC Input to Tie Cabinet Bypass (optional)  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
Amps  
278/262  
278/262  
120  
120  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
1+1  
G
---  
F
System Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 27)  
1/0  
(1)  
4
(1)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
AC Input to Tie Cabinet Bypass (optional)  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
556/524  
556/524  
240  
240  
2+0  
and  
2+1  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
G
---  
F
System Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 27)  
3/0  
(1)  
1/0  
(1)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
AC Input to Tie Cabinet Bypass (optional)  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
834/786  
834/786  
360  
360  
3+0  
and  
3+1  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
G
---  
F
System Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 27)  
1/0  
(2)  
2/0  
(1)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
AC Input to Tie Cabinet Bypass (optional)  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
1112/1048  
1112/1048  
480  
480  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
4+0  
Amps  
G
---  
System Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 27)  
2/0  
(2)  
2/0  
(1)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
NOTE: Callout letters D, F, and G map to Drawing 164201604---4, sheets 4 of 6, 5 of 6,  
and 6 of 6.  
DESCRIPTION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
12 of 15  
164201604---5  
DATE:  
B
032406  
®
A-23  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
Table P. INPUT/OUTPUT Ratings for Powerware 9390---120/120 and 9390---160/120 Parallel Systems  
Configuration  
Units  
Rating 50/60 Hz  
kVA  
kW  
120  
108  
120  
108  
Basic Unit Rating at 0.9 lagging pF load  
Input and Bypass Input  
Output  
VOLTS  
VOLTS  
208/220  
208/220  
480  
480  
AC Input from UPM  
Full Load Current for each Module  
Amps  
333/315  
144  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
All  
D
F
Minimum Conductor Size for each Module  
Number per Phase for each Module  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
See Table E through  
Table G for wire size.  
AC Input to Tie Cabinet Bypass (optional)  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
Amps  
333/315  
333/315  
144  
144  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
1+1  
G
---  
F
System Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 27)  
1/0  
(1)  
4
(1)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
AC Input to Tie Cabinet Bypass (optional)  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
666/630  
666/630  
288  
288  
2+0  
and  
2+1  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
G
---  
F
System Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 27)  
3/0  
(1)  
1/0  
(1)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
AC Input to Tie Cabinet Bypass (optional)  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
999/945  
999/945  
432  
432  
3+0  
and  
3+1  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
G
---  
F
System Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 27)  
1/0  
(2)  
2/0  
(1)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
AC Input to Tie Cabinet Bypass (optional)  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
1332/1260  
1332/1260  
576  
576  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
4+0  
Amps  
G
---  
System Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 27)  
2/0  
(2)  
2/0  
(1)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
NOTE: Callout letters D, F, and G map to Drawing 164201604---4, sheets 4 of 6, 5 of 6,  
and 6 of 6.  
DESCRIPTION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
13 of 15  
164201604---5  
DATE:  
B
032406  
®
A-24  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
Table Q. INPUT/OUTPUT Ratings for Powerware 9390---160/160 Parallel System  
Configuration  
Units  
Rating 50/60 Hz  
kVA  
kW  
160  
144  
160  
144  
Basic Unit Rating at 0.9 lagging pF load  
Input and Bypass Input  
Output  
VOLTS  
VOLTS  
208/220  
208/220  
480  
480  
AC Input from UPM  
Full Load Current for each Module  
Amps  
444/420  
192  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
All  
D
F
Minimum Conductor Size for each Module  
Number per Phase for each Module  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
See Table E through  
Table G for wire size.  
AC Input to Tie Cabinet Bypass (optional)  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
Amps  
444/420  
444/420  
192  
192  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
1+1  
G
---  
F
System Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 27)  
2/0  
(1)  
2
(1)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
AC Input to Tie Cabinet Bypass (optional)  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
888/840  
888/840  
384  
384  
2+0  
and  
2+1  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
G
---  
F
System Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 27)  
AC Input to Tie Cabinet Bypass (optional)  
Full Load Current  
1/0  
(2)  
1/0  
(1)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
Amps  
1332/1260  
1332/1260  
576  
576  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
3+0  
and  
3+1  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
G
---  
F
System Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 27)  
2/0  
(2)  
2/0  
(1)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
AC Input to Tie Cabinet Bypass (optional)  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
Amps  
1776/1680  
1776/1680  
768  
768  
AC Output to Critical Load  
Full Load Current  
(3) Phases, (1) Neutral---if required, (1) Ground  
4+0  
Amps  
G
---  
System Neutral Bonding Jumper  
Minimum Conductor Size  
Number (See Note 27)  
3/0  
(2)  
3/0  
(1)  
AWG or kcmil  
(each)  
NOTE: Callout letters D, F, and G map to Drawing 164201604---4, sheets 4 of 6, 5 of 6,  
and 6 of 6.  
DESCRIPTION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
14 of 15  
164201604---5  
DATE:  
B
032406  
®
A-25  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
32. Required parallel system wiring length must be in accordance with the following formula,  
as referenced to the diagram below, to ensure approximately equal current sharing when  
in Static Bypass mode:  
(Total length of 1A + 1B) (Total length of 2A + 2B) (Total length of 3A + 3B) (Total length of 4A + 4B)  
(30 + 25) (35 + 20) (40 + 15) (45 + 10)  
This rule has a tolerance of approximately ±10% for the combined input and output wire  
lengths.  
If installing only two UPMs in a fully redundant system, this requirement is no longer  
required, as each UPM is capable of supporting the full bypass requirement. However, this  
would preclude future expansion.  
UPM 1  
Bypass inputs to UPMs  
1A (30)  
2A (35)  
Battery  
UPM 2  
3A (40)  
4A (45)  
Battery  
UPM 3  
Outputs from UPMs  
1B (25)  
2B (20)  
Battery  
UPM 4  
3B (15)  
4B (10)  
Battery  
DESCRIPTION:  
POWER WIRING INSTALLATION NOTES  
NOTE: Wire lengths in the diagram and  
DRAWING NO:  
SHEET:  
formula are in feet and are for  
example only.  
164201604---5  
15 of 15  
REVISION:  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-26  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
REMOVE DEBRIS SHIELD  
COVERING EXHAUST GRILL  
BEFORE OPERATING SYSTEM.  
TOP ENTRY CONDUIT LANDING  
FOR AC INPUT AND OUTPUT,  
DC INPUT, DC CONTROL, AND  
INTERFACE CONNECTIONS.  
(REMOVE PANEL TO DRILL OR  
PUNCH CONDUIT HOLES.)  
TOP VIEW  
CONDUIT LANDINGS FOR  
X-SLOT CONNECTIONS.  
(REMOVE PANELS TO DRILL OR  
PUNCH CONDUIT HOLES.)  
BOTTOM ENTRY CONDUIT  
LANDING FOR AC INPUT AND  
OUTPUT, DC INPUT, DC  
CONTROL, AND INTERFACE  
CONNECTIONS.  
(REMOVE PANEL TO DRILL OR  
PUNCH CONDUIT HOLES.)  
BOTTOM VIEW  
DESCRIPTION:  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
CONDUIT AND WIRE ENTRY LOCATIONS  
SHEET:  
164201604---6  
A
1 of 2  
DATE:  
091505  
®
A-27  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
INTER-CABINET WIRING  
ACCESS KNOCKOUTS. REMOVE  
KNOCKOUTS, AS REQUIRED, TO  
ROUTE WIRES BETWEEN  
CABINETS. (INSTALL NYLON  
GROMMET AFTER REMOVAL OF  
KNOCKOUTS.)  
INSIDE PANELS  
LEFT SIDE VIEW  
RIGHT SIDE VIEW  
INTER-CABINET WIRING ACCESS  
KNOCKOUTS. REMOVE KNOCKOUTS,  
AS REQUIRED, TO ROUTE WIRES  
BETWEEN CABINETS. (INSTALL NYLON  
GROMMET AFTER REMOVAL OF  
KNOCKOUTS.)  
DESCRIPTION:  
CONDUIT AND WIRE ENTRY LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---6  
A
2 of 2  
DATE:  
091505  
®
A-28  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
WIREWAY FOR TOP  
ENTRY POWER WIRING  
AC INPUT TO UPS  
RECTIFIER AND BYPASS  
(A, B, C, N)  
AC OUTPUT TO CRITICAL  
LOAD  
(A, B, C, N)  
SEE SHEET 2  
FOR DETAILS  
DC INPUT FROM BATTERY  
TO UPS  
(+ AND --- )  
GROUND TERMINALS  
MODELS 120/100 AND 120/120  
480V INPUT AND 480V OUTPUT  
NOTE: Metal shields covering wiring  
DESCRIPTION:  
UPS POWER TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
terminals must be removed or  
opened to gain access to  
terminals.  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---7  
B
1 of 4  
DATE:  
032406  
®
A-29  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
TERMINAL DETAIL  
RIGHT SIDE VIEW  
BYPASS INPUT  
TERMINALS  
SINGLE-FEED  
JUMPERS  
RECTIFIER INPUT  
TERMINALS  
PHASE A (E6)  
PHASE A (E1)  
AC INPUT TO  
UPS RECTIFIER  
AND BYPASS  
AC INPUT TO UPS  
BYPASS  
(DUAL INPUT)  
(SINGLE INPUT)  
PHASE B (E7)  
PHASE C (E8)  
PHASE B (E2)  
PHASE C (E3)  
AC INPUT TO  
UPS RECTIFIER  
(DUAL INPUT)  
PHASE A (E9)  
PHASE B (E10)  
PHASE C (E11)  
NEUTRAL  
TERMINALS  
(E12)  
AC OUTPUT TO  
CRITICAL LOAD  
OUTPUT  
TERMINALS  
+
(E4)  
(E5)  
DC INPUT  
FROM BATTERY  
---  
MODELS 120/100 AND 120/120  
480V INPUT AND 480V OUTPUT  
DESCRIPTION:  
UPS POWER TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---7  
A
2 of 4  
DATE:  
091505  
®
A-30  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
WIREWAY FOR TOP  
ENTRY POWER WIRING  
NOT USED ON 120/100 AND  
120/120 208V/220V RATINGS  
AC INPUT TO UPS  
RECTIFIER AND BYPASS  
(A, B, C, N)  
AC OUTPUT TO CRITICAL  
LOAD  
(A, B, C, N)  
SEE SHEET 4  
FOR DETAILS  
DC INPUT FROM BATTERY  
TO UPS  
(+ AND --- )  
GROUND TERMINALS  
USED ONLY ON 160/100,  
160/120, AND 160/160  
208V/220V RATINGS  
MODELS 120/100, 120/120, 160/100, 160/120, AND 160/160  
208V/220V INPUT AND 208V/220V OUTPUT  
MODELS 160/100, 160/120, AND 160/160  
480V INPUT AND 480V OUTPUT  
DESCRIPTION:  
UPS POWER TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
NOTE: Metal shields covering wiring  
terminals must be removed or  
opened to gain access to  
terminals.  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---7  
B
3 of 4  
DATE:  
032406  
®
A-31  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
TERMINAL DETAIL  
RIGHT SIDE VIEW  
BYPASS INPUT  
TERMINALS  
RECTIFIER INPUT  
TERMINALS  
PHASE A (E6)  
PHASE B (E7)  
AC INPUT TO  
UPS RECTIFIER  
AND BYPASS  
PHASE A (E1)  
AC INPUT TO  
UPS BYPASS  
(DUAL INPUT)  
(SINGLE INPUT)  
PHASE B (E2)  
AC INPUT TO  
UPS RECTIFIER  
(DUAL INPUT)  
PHASE C (E8)  
PHASE C (E3)  
NEUTRAL  
TERMINALS  
(E12)  
PHASE A (E9)  
PHASE B (E10)  
PHASE C (E11)  
AC OUTPUT TO  
CRITICAL LOAD  
+
(E4)  
(E5)  
DC INPUT  
FROM BATTERY  
---  
MODELS 120/100, 120/120, 160/100, 160/120, AND 160/160  
208V/220V INPUT AND 208V/220V OUTPUT  
MODELS 160/100, 160/120, AND 160/160  
480V INPUT AND 480V OUTPUT  
DESCRIPTION:  
UPS POWER TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---7  
A
4 of 4  
DATE:  
091505  
®
A-32  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
1. Use Class 1 wiring methods (as defined by the NEC) for interface wiring up to 30V. The  
wire should be rated at 24V, 1A minimum.  
2. Use Class 2 wiring methods (as defined by the NEC) for interface wiring from 30 to 600V.  
3. When installing external interface wiring (for example, building alarm, relay output, battery  
breaker trip, and X-Slot) to the UPS interface terminals, conduit must be installed between  
each device and the UPS cabinet. Install the interface wiring in separate conduit from the  
power wiring.  
4. When installing internal interface wiring to X-Slot terminals, route the wiring through the  
internal opening in the X-Slot communication bay.  
5. All building alarm inputs or remote features require an isolated normally-open contact or  
switch (rated at 24 Vdc, 20 mA minimum) connected between the alarm input and  
common terminal as shown. All control wiring and relay and switch contacts are  
customer-supplied. Use twisted-pair wires for each alarm input and common.  
6. The building alarms can be programmed to display the alarm functional name.  
7. See Table R through Table X and Chapters 3, 5, and 6 for customer interface wiring.  
8. LAN and telephone drops for use with X-Slot connectivity cards must be provided by  
facility planners or the customer.  
Table R. TB1 and TB2 Interface Connections  
Terminal TB1  
Name  
Description  
1
2
3
4
5
Remote EPO NC  
Remote EPO Common  
Remote EPO NO  
Remote EPO Common  
Battery Breaker Aux  
Battery Breaker Aux  
Return  
Normally-closed dry contacts used to activate EPO  
of UPS from a remote switch  
Normally-open dry contacts used to activate EPO of  
UPS from a remote switch  
Contacts used to indicate whether UPS battery  
breaker or disconnect is open or closed.  
6
7
8
9
10  
Battery UVR (+)  
Battery UVR (---)  
Building Alarm 1  
Building Alarm 1 Return  
Name  
Contacts used to open battery breaker or  
disconnect.  
Programmable UPS alarm. Activated by a remote  
dry contact closure.  
Terminal TB2  
Description  
Programmable UPS alarm. Activated by a remote  
dry contact closure. Also used for backup control  
(pull chain) for parallel operation.  
Normally-open contact closes when UPS is on  
bypass. Also used for backup control (pull chain)  
for parallel operation.  
1
2
3
4
Building Alarm 2  
Building Alarm 2 Return  
On Bypass Return  
On Bypass NO  
5
6
7
8
9
Alarm Relay NC  
Alarm Relay Common  
Alarm Relay NO  
Alarm Relay Common  
On Inverter NC  
On Inverter Return  
General purpose normally-closed relay contact.  
General purpose normally-open relay contact.  
Normally-closed contact opens when output  
contactor closes.  
10  
DESCRIPTION:  
INTERFACE WIRING INSTALLATION  
NOTES AND TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
SHEET:  
164201604---8  
B
1 of 13  
REVISION:  
DATE:  
032406  
®
A-33  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
INTERFACE TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
MINI-CSB BUILDING  
STANDARD  
X-SLOT COMMUNICATION BAY  
ALARM TERMINAL  
BLOCK P5  
X-SLOTS  
1
3
4
2
TB1  
TB2  
OPTIONAL MINI-CSB  
OPTIONAL X-SLOT  
COMMUNICATION BAY  
WIREWAY FOR BOTTOM ENTRY  
INTERFACE WIRING  
DESCRIPTION:  
NOTE: Metal shields covering wiring  
terminals must be removed or  
opened to gain access to  
terminals.  
INTERFACE WIRING INSTALLATION  
NOTES AND TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
2 of 13  
164201604---8  
DATE:  
B
032406  
®
A-34  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
INTERFACE TERMINALS  
UPS  
JUMPER REQUIRED  
IF NOT USED  
REMOTE EPO NC  
EPO COMMON  
REMOTE EPO NO  
EPO COMMON  
1
BATTERY BREAKER AUX  
BATTERY BREAKER AUX RETURN  
BATTERY UVR (+)  
TB1  
TB2  
BAT TERY UVR ( --- )  
BUILDING ALARM 1  
BUILDING ALARM 1 RETURN  
10  
1
BUILDING ALARM 2  
BUILDING ALARM 2 RETURN  
ON BYPASS RETURN  
ON BYPASS NO  
ALARM RELAY NC  
ALARM RELAY COMMON  
ALARM RELAY NO  
10  
ALARM RELAY COMMON  
ON INVERTER NC  
ON INVERTER RETURN  
NOTE: 1. All building alarm inputs require an isolated normally-open or  
normally-closed contact or switch (rated at 24 Vdc, 20 mA minimum)  
connected between the alarm input and common terminal as shown. Building  
alarm inputs can be programmed for use with either normally-open or  
normally-closed contacts. All control wiring and relay and switch contacts are  
customer-supplied.  
2. The building alarms can be programmed to display the alarm functional  
name.  
3. A jumper wire must be connected between pins 1 and 2 on TB1, if the  
normally-closed EPO contact is not used.  
DESCRIPTION:  
INTERFACE WIRING INSTALLATION  
NOTES AND TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
3 of 13  
164201604---8  
DATE:  
B
032406  
®
A-35  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
MINI-CSB INTERFACE TERMINALS  
MINI-CSB  
BUILDING ALARM 3  
BUILDING ALARM 3 RETURN  
BUILDING ALARM 4  
BUILDING ALARM 4 RETURN  
BUILDING ALARM 5  
BUILDING ALARM 5 RETURN  
BUILDING ALARM 6  
BUILDING ALARM 6 RETURN  
1
8
P5  
NOTE: 1. All building alarm inputs require an isolated normally-open or  
normally-closed contact or switch (rated at 24 Vdc, 20 mA minimum)  
connected between the alarm input and common terminal as shown. Building  
alarm inputs can be programmed for use with either normally-open or  
normally-closed contacts. All control wiring and relay and switch contacts are  
customer-supplied.  
2. The building alarms can be programmed to display the alarm functional  
name.  
DESCRIPTION:  
INTERFACE WIRING INSTALLATION  
NOTES AND TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
4 of 13  
164201604---8  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-36  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
9. The UPS DC UVR trip and Battery Aux signal wiring from the UPS must be connected to  
the DC source disconnect device.  
10. Battery Aux and UVR wiring should be a minimum of 18 AWG.  
Table S. Battery Disconnect Interface  
BATTERY  
BREAKER OR  
DISCONNECT  
UPS  
TB1  
5
6
7
8
BATTERY AUX +  
BAT TERY AUX ---  
BATTERY UVR +  
BAT TERY UVR ---  
Table T. Alarm Relay Contact  
TB2  
ALARM RELAY  
5
5
7
8
UPS  
CONTACT RATING  
Switched Voltage:  
277 Vac  
28 Vdc  
Maximum Current: 5A  
Minimum Wire Size: 22 AWG  
NOTE: Relays are shown in de-energized state. Relays change state when the  
UPS is in Normal mode.  
DESCRIPTION:  
INTERFACE WIRING INSTALLATION  
NOTES AND TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
5 of 13  
164201604---8  
DATE:  
B
032406  
®
A-37  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
11. The Remote EPO feature opens all contactors in the UPS cabinet and isolates power from  
your critical load. Local electrical codes may also require tripping upstream protective  
devices to the UPS. This switch must be a dedicated latching-type switch not tied into any  
other circuit.  
12. A jumper wire must be connected between pins 1 and 2 on TB1, if a normally-closed EPO  
switch is not used or a normally-open EPO switch is used.  
13. Remote EPO wiring should be a minimum of 22 AWG.  
Table U. Remote EPO  
LATCHING-TYPE  
UPS TB1  
1 (NC)  
SWITCH ONLY  
REMOTE  
EPO  
INSTALL JUMPER  
IF SWITCH NOT  
INSTALLED THIS  
POSITION  
SWITCH  
(NC TYPE)  
2 (COMMON)  
3 (NO)  
TWISTED  
WIRES  
OR  
REMOTE  
EPO  
SWITCH  
(NO TYPE)  
4 (COMMON)  
TWISTED  
WIRES  
LATCHING-TYPE  
SWITCH ONLY  
Remote EPO switch rating is 24 Vdc, 1A minimum.  
NOTE: This switch must be a dedicated latching-type switch not  
tied into any other circuits.  
DESCRIPTION:  
INTERFACE WIRING INSTALLATION  
NOTES AND TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
6 of 13  
164201604---8  
DATE:  
B
032406  
®
A-38  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
14. Wire the maintenance bypass auxiliary contacts as applicable. See Table V.  
Table V. Typical Maintenance Bypass Panel Auxiliary Contact Control Wiring  
MAINTENANCE BYPASS PANEL  
(PROVIDED BY OTHERS)  
NOTE: REFER TO THE INSTRUCTIONS  
PROVIDED WITH THE MAINTENANCE  
BYPASS PANEL FOR WIRING INSTRUCTIONS.  
N. O.  
MBP  
AUX 1  
COMMON  
3
4
TB2  
UPS  
AUX CONTACT RATING  
Refer to the instructions provided with the maintenance bypass panel  
for auxiliary contact ratings.  
Minimum Wire Size: 22 AWG  
DESCRIPTION:  
INTERFACE WIRING INSTALLATION  
NOTES AND TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
7 of 13  
164201604---8  
DATE:  
B
032406  
®
A-39  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
15. 120 Vac should be provided from the critical bus by facility planners or the customer. See  
Table W.  
Table W. Typical Maintenance Bypass Panel Key Switch Control Wiring  
MAINTENANCE BYPASS PANEL  
(PROVIDED BY OTHERS)  
Solenoid  
Neutral  
Key  
Switch  
NOTE: THE RED OK TO GO TO  
MAINTENANCE BYPASS  
ILLUMINATES ONLY WHEN THE  
UPS MODULE IS NOT ONLINE (K3  
OUTPUT CONTACTOR IS OPEN).  
Lamp  
120 VAC  
Fused  
9
10  
TB2  
Output  
Contactor  
K3  
UPS  
K3 AUX CONTACT RATING  
Switched Voltage:  
120 Vac at 6A Maximum  
240 Vac at 4A Maximum  
24 Vdc at 6A Maximum  
Minimum Wire Size: 22 AWG  
DESCRIPTION:  
INTERFACE WIRING INSTALLATION  
NOTES AND TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
8 of 13  
164201604---8  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-40  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
16. Conduit must be installed between the UPM cabinets for parallel interface wiring. Install the  
interface wiring in separate conduit from the power wiring.  
17. Use Class 1 wiring methods (as defined by the NEC) for parallel interface wiring. The wire  
should be shielded twisted pair, rated for 5 amps maximum.  
18. See Table X and Chapter 6 for Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card interface wiring.  
Table X. Powerware Hot Sync CAN Bridge Card Interface Connections  
Terminal J3  
Name  
Description  
1
2
Alarm  
Alarm Rtn  
Programmable UPS alarm. Activated by a remote  
dry contact closure.  
Normally-closed contact opens when UPS is on  
bypass.  
Bypass contact return.  
Normally-open contact closes when UPS is on  
bypass.  
3
4
5
Alarm Relay NC  
Alarm Relay Com  
Alarm Relay NO  
Remote Monitor Panel II (RMP II), Relay Interface  
Module II (RIM II), and Supervisory Contact  
Module II (SCM II) connections.  
6
7
TX  
TX  
8
9
10  
CAN L  
CAN H  
Shield  
Computer Area Network (CAN) Input for parallel  
operation.  
J3  
CONNECTIONS FOR PARALLEL SYSTEM CONTROL  
CONNECTIONS FOR RMP II, RIM II, OR SCM II  
CONNECTIONS FOR BYPASS STATUS  
BUILDING ALARM 2 REPLACEMENT  
POWERWARE HOT SYNC CAN BRIDGE CARD  
DESCRIPTION:  
INTERFACE WIRING INSTALLATION  
NOTES AND TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
NOTE: All interface wiring is to be provided DRAWING NO:  
SHEET:  
9 of 13  
164201604---8  
by the customer.  
REVISION:  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-41  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
CAN  
PULL CHAIN  
UPM  
1
UPM  
2
UPM  
3
UPM  
4
(IF INSTALLED)  
(IF INSTALLED)  
NOTE: This drawing is for parallel wiring purposes and is not a floor layout plan.  
UPMs can be placed in any physical order.  
PARALLEL SYSTEM CAN AND BACKUP CONTROL (PULL CHAIN)  
CAN Wiring Terminations  
To UPM 3 CAN Card  
To UPM 4 CAN Card  
(If Installed)  
From UPM 1 CAN Card To UPM 2 CAN Card  
(If Installed)  
J3–8 (L)  
J3–9 (H)  
J3–8 (L)  
J3–9 (H)  
J3–8 (L)  
J3–9 (H)  
J3–8 (L)  
J3–9 (H)  
J3–10 (Shield)  
J3–10 (Shield)  
J3–10 (Shield)  
J3–10 (Shield)  
TWISTED PAIR  
TWISTED PAIR  
TWISTED PAIR  
UPM 2  
CAN CARD J3  
UPM 1  
CAN CARD J3  
UPM 3  
CAN CARD J3  
(IF INSTALLED)  
UPM 4  
CAN CARD J3  
(IF INSTALLED)  
PARALLEL SYSTEM CAN WIRING  
DESCRIPTION:  
INTERFACE WIRING INSTALLATION  
NOTES AND TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
10 of 13  
164201604---8  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-42  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
Building Alarm Pull Chain Wiring Terminations  
To UPM 3  
(If Installed)  
To UPM 4  
(If Installed)  
From UPM 1  
To UPM 2  
TB2–1 (BA 2)  
TB2–2 (Rtn)  
TB2–1 (BA 2)  
TB2–2 (Rtn)  
TB2–1 (BA 2)  
TB2–2 (Rtn)  
TB2–1 (BA 2)  
TB2–2 (Rtn)  
Bypass Relay Pull Chain Wiring Terminations  
All UPMs  
From  
To  
TB2–1 (BA 2)  
TB2–2 (BA 2 Rtn)  
TB2–3 (Byp)  
TB2–4 (Byp Rtn)  
TWISTED PAIR  
TWISTED PAIR  
TWISTED PAIR  
TB1  
TB1  
TB1  
TB1  
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
7
8
7
8
7
8
9
9
9
9
10  
10  
10  
10  
TB2  
TB2  
TB2  
TB2  
1
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
1
2
3
TWISTED  
PAIR  
4
5
6
4
5
6
TWISTED  
PAIR  
TWISTED  
PAIR  
TWISTED  
PAIR  
5
6
7
8
7
8
7
8
7
8
9
9
9
9
10  
10  
10  
10  
UPM 1  
UPM 2  
UPM 3  
(IF INSTALLED)  
UPM 4  
(IF INSTALLED)  
PARALLEL SYSTEM BACKUP  
CONTROL (PULL CHAIN)  
WIRING  
DESCRIPTION:  
INTERFACE WIRING INSTALLATION  
NOTES AND TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
11 of 13  
164201604---8  
DATE:  
B
032406  
®
A-43  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
GROUND  
TERMINAL  
TERMINAL TB–1  
SIGNAL CONNECTIONS  
FROM THE UPS  
TERMINAL TB–3  
120 VAC POWER  
REMOTE MONITOR PANEL AND RELAY  
INTERFACE MODULE TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
TERMINAL TB–3  
120 VAC POWER  
GROUND  
TERMINAL  
TERMINAL TB–2  
CUSTOMER SUPERVISORY  
CONTACT INTERFACE  
TERMINAL TB–1  
SIGNAL CONNECTIONS  
FROM THE UPS  
SUPERVISORY CONTACT MODULE  
TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DESCRIPTION:  
INTERFACE WIRING INSTALLATION  
NOTES AND TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
12 of 13  
164201604---8  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-44  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
19. Conduit must be installed between the UPS cabinet and the RMP II, RIM II, or SCM II for  
signal wiring. Conduit must be installed between the device and the power source for  
power wiring. Install the signal wiring in separate conduit from the power wiring.  
20. Conduit and wiring between the UPS and the RMP II, RIM II, or SCM II is to be supplied by  
the customer.  
21. Maximum distance between the UPS cabinet and RMP II, RIM II, or SCM II is not to exceed  
500 feet.  
22. Use Class 1 wiring methods (as defined by the NEC) for RMP II, RIM II, or SCM II power  
and signal wiring. Power wiring should be a minimum of 22 AWG and a maximum of  
14 AWG. The wire should be rated for 1A minimum.  
23. RMP II, RIM II, or SCM II signal wiring should be a minimum of 22 AWG and a maximum of  
14 AWG. The wire should be twisted pair, rated for 5A maximum.  
24. Use only 75°C copper wire.  
25. 120 Vac for the RMP II, RIM II, or SCM II should be provided from the critical bus by facility  
planners or the customer.  
26. See Table X and Chapter 6 for CAN Bridge Card and RMP II, RIM II, or SCM II installation.  
RMP, RIM, or SCM Wiring Terminations  
Tightening Torque  
From UPS CAN Card  
To RMP, RIM, or SCM  
Remarks  
Nm (lb in)  
0.9 (8)  
J3–6 (TX)  
J3–7 (TX)  
N/A  
TB1–5 (RDX )  
*
Use Twisted Pair  
TB1–4 (RDX)  
TB3 Line  
0.9 (8)  
0.9 (8)  
N/A  
N/A  
TB3 Neutral  
Ground Terminal  
0.9 (8)  
2.7 (24) Maximum  
GROUND  
TERMINAL  
120 VAC  
FROM  
CRITICAL  
BUS  
NEUTRAL  
LINE  
UPS CAN  
CARD J3  
RMP II, RIM II, OR SCM II  
TWISTED PAIR  
DESCRIPTION:  
INTERFACE WIRING INSTALLATION  
NOTES AND TERMINAL LOCATIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
13 of 13  
164201604---8  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-45  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
FRONT VIEW  
RIGHT SIDE VIEW  
DESCRIPTION:  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
UPS CABINET DIMENSIONS  
SHEET:  
164201604---9  
A
1 of 4  
DATE:  
Dimensions are in millimeters [inches]  
091505  
®
A-46  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
TOP VIEW  
LEFT SIDE  
RIGHT SIDE  
FRONT  
BOTTOM  
VIEW  
LEFT SIDE  
RIGHT SIDE  
FRONT  
DESCRIPTION:  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
UPS CABINET DIMENSIONS  
SHEET:  
2 of 4  
164201604---9  
DATE:  
Dimensions are in millimeters [inches]  
A
091505  
®
A-47  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
RIGHT SIDE  
LEFT SIDE  
FRONT  
BOTTOM VIEW WITH OPTIONAL FLOOR MOUNTING BRACKETS  
DESCRIPTION:  
UPS CABINET DIMENSIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
3 of 4  
164201604---9  
DATE:  
Dimensions are in millimeters [inches]  
A
091505  
®
A-48  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
RIGHT SIDE  
LEFT SIDE  
FRONT  
SEISMIC KIT INSTALLATION  
BOTTOM VIEW WITH OPTIONAL SEISMIC MOUNTING BRACKETS  
DESCRIPTION:  
UPS CABINET DIMENSIONS  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
4 of 4  
164201604---9  
DATE:  
Dimensions are in millimeters [inches]  
A
091505  
®
A-49  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
11.9  
(0.47)  
115.8  
(4.56)  
88.9  
(3.50)  
95.3  
114.3  
(4.50)  
(3.75)  
SQUARE  
1/2 in. Knockout Pattern  
typ. 5 sides  
NOTE: 1. Conduit and wiring between the  
Remote Emergency Power-off (REPO)  
and the UPS to be supplied by the  
customer.  
TO OTHER  
EQUIPMENT  
TO UPS  
2. Maximum distance between the  
Remote EPO and the UPS not to exceed  
500 feet.  
3. Maximum wire size #14 AWG.  
Minimum wire size #22 AWG.  
DESCRIPTION:  
OPTIONAL POWERWARE REMOTE  
EMERGENCY POWER-OFF  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---10  
A
1 of 1  
DATE:  
Dimensions are in millimeters [inches]  
091505  
®
A-50  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
KNOCKOUTS PROVIDED  
ON FIVE SURFACES  
FLUSH MOUNT  
USE #10 PAN  
HEAD SCREWS  
(MOUNT WITH VENT  
HOLES FACING UP)  
SURFACE MOUNT  
USE #10 PAN  
HEAD SCREWS  
(FOR HANGING)  
(MOUNT WITH VENT  
HOLES FACING UP)  
DESCRIPTION:  
OPTIONAL REMOTE MONITOR PANEL  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---11  
A
1 of 1  
DATE:  
Dimensions are in millimeters [inches]  
091505  
®
A-51  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
KNOCKOUTS PROVIDED  
ON FIVE SURFACES  
FLUSH MOUNT  
USE #10 PAN  
HEAD SCREWS  
(MOUNT WITH VENT  
HOLES FACING UP)  
SURFACE MOUNT  
USE #10 PAN  
HEAD SCREWS  
(FOR HANGING)  
(MOUNT WITH VENT  
HOLES FACING UP)  
DESCRIPTION:  
OPTIONAL RELAY INTERFACE MODULE  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---12  
A
1 of 2  
DATE:  
Dimensions are in millimeters [inches]  
091505  
®
A-52  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
15–PIN D–SUB CONNECTORS  
DESCRIPTION:  
OPTIONAL RELAY INTERFACE MODULE  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---12  
2 of 2  
DATE:  
A
091505  
®
A-53  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Information  
---  
KNOCKOUTS PROVIDED  
ON FIVE SURFACES  
FLUSH MOUNT  
USE # 10 PAN  
HEAD SCREWS  
(MOUNT WITH VENT  
HOLES FACING UP)  
SURFACE MOUNT  
USE # 10 PAN  
HEAD SCREWS  
(FOR HANGING)  
(MOUNT WITH VENT  
HOLES FACING UP)  
DESCRIPTION:  
OPTIONAL SUPERVISORY CONTACT  
MODULE  
DRAWING NO:  
REVISION:  
SHEET:  
164201604---13  
A
1 of 1  
DATE:  
Dimensions are in millimeters [inches]  
091505  
®
A-54  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Warranty  
®
LIMITED FACTORY WARRANTY FOR THREE-PHASE POWERWARE PRODUCTS  
WARRANTOR: The warrantor for the limited warranties set forth herein is Eaton Electrical Inc., a Delaware Corporation (“Eaton”).  
LIMITED WARRANTY: This limited warranty (this “Warranty”) applies only to the original end-user (the “End-User”) of the Powerware  
Three-Phase UPS Products (the “Product”) and cannot be transferred. This Warranty applies even in the event that the Product is initially  
sold by Eaton for resale to an End-User.  
LIMITED WARRANTY PERIOD: The period covered by this Warranty for Product installed [and currently located] in the fifty (50) United  
States and the District of Columbia is twelve (12) months from the date of Product start-up or eighteen (18) months from the date of  
Product shipment, whichever occurs first, for parts coverage and 90 days from the date of Product start-up for labor coverage. The  
period covered by this Warranty for Product installed [and currently located] outside of the fifty (50) United States and the District of  
Columbia is twelve (12) months from the date of Product start-up or eighteen (18) months from the date of Product shipment,  
whichever occurs first, for parts coverage.  
WHAT THIS LIMITED WARRANTY COVERS: The warrantor warrants that the Powerware three-phase UPS electronics, Eaton-built  
accessories, and Powerware-built battery cabinets (individually and collectively, the ”Warranted Items”) are free from defects in material  
and workmanship. If, in the opinion of Eaton, a Warranted Item is defective and the defect is within the terms of this Warranty, Eaton’s  
sole obligation will be to repair or replace such defective item (including by providing service, parts, and labor, as applicable), at the  
option of Eaton. The Warranted Item will be repaired or replaced onsite at the End-User’s location or such other location as determined  
by Eaton. Any parts that are replaced may be new or reconditioned. All parts replaced by Eaton shall become the property of Eaton.  
WHAT THIS LIMITED WARRANTY DOES NOT COVER: This Warranty does not cover any defects or damages caused by: (a) failure to  
properly store the Product before installation, including the ”trickle charge” of batteries no later than the date indicated on the  
packaging; (b) shipping and delivery of the Product if shipping is FOB Factory; (c) neglect, accident, abuse, misuse, misapplication,  
incorrect installation; (d) repair or alteration not authorized in writing by Eaton personnel or performed by an authorized Eaton  
Customer Service Engineer or Agent; or (e) improper testing, operation, maintenance, adjustment, or any modification of any kind not  
authorized in writing by Eaton personnel or performed by an authorized Eaton Customer Service Engineer or Agent.  
This Warranty is not valid: (a) unless an authorized Eaton Customer Service Engineer (in the USA) or Agent (outside of the USA) performs  
startup and commissioning of the Product; (b) if the Product is moved to a new location by someone other than an authorized Eaton  
Customer Service Engineer (in the USA) or Agent (outside of the USA); or (c) if the Product’s serial numbers have been removed or are  
illegible. Any Warranted Items repaired or replaced pursuant to this Warranty will be warranted for the remaining portion of the original  
Warranty subject to all the terms thereof. Labor warranty is not provided for Product located outside of the fifty (50) United States or  
the District of Columbia. Any equipment, parts, or materials included in the Product and not manufactured by Eaton are  
warranted solely by the manufacturer of such equipment, parts, or materials and are not included as part of this Warranty.  
Batteries are not warranted by Eaton.  
THIS WARRANTY IS THE END-USER’S SOLE REMEDY AND IS EXPRESSLY IN LIEU OF, AND THERE ARE NO OTHER EXPRESSED OR  
IMPLIED GUARANTEES OR WARRANTIES (INCLUDING ANY IMPLIED WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY  
PURPOSE, WHICH ARE EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMED).  
LIMITATION OF LIABILITY: In no event shall Eaton be liable for any indirect, incidental, special, or consequential damages of any kind  
or type whatsoever, or based on any claim or cause of action, however denominated. Eaton shall not be responsible for failure to provide  
service or parts due to causes beyond Eaton’s reasonable control. In no case will Eaton’s liability under this Warranty exceed the  
replacement value of the Warranted Items.  
END-USER’S OBLIGATIONS: In order to receive the benefits of this Warranty, the End-User must use the Product in a normal way,  
follow the Product’s operation and maintenance manual, and protect against further damage to the Product if there is a covered defect.  
OTHER LIMITATIONS: Eaton’s obligations under this Warranty are expressly conditioned upon receipt by Eaton of all payments due to  
it (including interest charges, if any). During such time as Eaton has not received payment of any amount due to it for the Product, in  
accordance with the contract terms under which the Product is sold, Eaton shall have no obligation under this Warranty. Also during  
such time, the period of this Warranty shall continue to run and the expiration of this Warranty shall not be extended upon payment of  
any overdue or unpaid amounts.  
COSTS NOT RELATED TO WARRANTY: The End-User shall be invoiced for, and shall pay for, all services not expressly provided for by  
the terms of this Warranty, including without limitation site calls involving an inspection that determines no corrective maintenance is  
required. Any costs for replacement equipment, installation, materials, freight charges, travel expenses, or labor of Eaton representatives  
outside the terms of this Warranty will be borne by the End-User.  
OBTAINING WARRANTY SERVICE: In the USA, call the Eaton Customer Reliability Center 7x24 at 800-843-9433. Outside of the USA,  
call your local Eaton sales or service representative, or call the Eaton Customer Reliability Center in the USA at 919-870-3028. For  
comments or questions about this Limited Factory Warranty, write to the Customer Quality Representative, 3301 Spring Forest Road,  
Raleigh, North Carolina 27616 USA.  
®
W-1  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Warranty  
This page intentionally left blank.  
®
W-2  
EATON Powerware 9390 UPS (100–160 kVA) Installation and Operation Manual S 164201604 Rev B powerware.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
*164201604B*  
164201604 B  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Pentax Digital Camera IQZcom200 User Manual
Philips Cable Box SWW1810 User Manual
Philips Computer Monitor 107E66 User Manual
Philips Flat Panel Television 19PFL3403 77 User Manual
Philips Hair Dryer HP8195 00 User Manual
Philips Stereo Receiver TC8276 Series User Manual
Philips TV DVD Combo 00 User Manual
Philips Universal Remote SRU4106 User Manual
Phoenix Gold Car Amplifier TI15001 User Manual
Plinius Audio MP3 Player TIKI Network Audio Player User Manual